blob: 5884507b51956f6b7e9d0432808e9a3781267897 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4c67bd62021-10-08 18:22:24 +02007 2021/10/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600616quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600695that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600700Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
701if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
702or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
703
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
706 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
707
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100708When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
709double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600710and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100711a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
712a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
713the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
714regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
715around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
716more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200717
718
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007192.3. Environment variables
720--------------------------
721
722HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
723interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
724configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
725optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
726shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200727underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
728list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
729arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
730before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200731
732 Example:
733
734 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
735
736 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
737
738 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
739
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200740Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
741file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200742
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
744 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
745
746* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
747 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
748 directory.
749
750* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
751
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500752* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200753 processes, separated by semicolons.
754
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500755* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200756 CLI, separated by semicolons.
757
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200758In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
759regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
760only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
761
762* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
763
764* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
765 starting at one.
766
767* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
768 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
769 first section.
770
771These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
772if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
773section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
774"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
775proxies.
776
777This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
778logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
779to name some config objects like servers for example.
780
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200781See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200782
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100783
7842.4. Conditional blocks
785-----------------------
786
787It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
788some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
789ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
790configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
791versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
792preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
793text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
794lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
795switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
796are defined to form conditional blocks:
797
798 - .if <condition>
799 - .elif <condition>
800 - .else
801 - .endif
802
803The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
804as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
805matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
806there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
807only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
808".elif" of a block.
809
810Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
811ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
812as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
813
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200814Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
815See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
816
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200817The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
818expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100819
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200823 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530824 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
825 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200826 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
827 from left to right until one returns false
828 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
829 from right to left until one returns true
830
831Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
832operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200833
834The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
835
836 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
837 exists, regardless of its contents
838
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200839 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
840 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
841 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
842
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200843 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
844 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
845
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200846 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
847 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
848 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
849 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
850
851 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
852 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
853 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
854 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
855
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200856Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200858 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
859 listen mwcli_px
860 bind :1111
861 ...
862 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100863
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
865 bind :80
866 .endif
867
868 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200869 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200870 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200871 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200874 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200875 bind :443 ssl crt ...
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200878 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
879 profiling.memory on
880 .endif
881
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200882 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
883 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
884 .endif
885
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200886Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200888 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100889 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
890 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
891 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
892
893Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
894"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
895fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
896provide advice to the user.
897
898Example:
899
900 .if "${A}"
901 .if "${B}"
902 .notice "A=1, B=1"
903 .elif "${C}"
904 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
905 .elif "${D}"
906 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
907 .else
908 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
909 .endif
910 .else
911 .notice "A=0"
912 .endif
913
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200914 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
915 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
916
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100917
9182.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200919----------------
920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100921Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100922values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
923otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
924numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
925for every keyword. Supported units are :
926
927 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
928 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
929 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
930 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
931 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
932 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
933
934
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009352.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200936-------------
937
938 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
939 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
940 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
941 global
942 daemon
943 maxconn 256
944
945 defaults
946 mode http
947 timeout connect 5000ms
948 timeout client 50000ms
949 timeout server 50000ms
950
951 frontend http-in
952 bind *:80
953 default_backend servers
954
955 backend servers
956 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
957
958
959 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
960 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
961 global
962 daemon
963 maxconn 256
964
965 defaults
966 mode http
967 timeout connect 5000ms
968 timeout client 50000ms
969 timeout server 50000ms
970
971 listen http-in
972 bind *:80
973 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
974
975
976Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
977
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100978 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200979
980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009813. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982--------------------
983
984Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
985are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
986of them have command-line equivalents.
987
988The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
989
990 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200991 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200994 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200996 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - description
998 - deviceatlas-json-file
999 - deviceatlas-log-level
1000 - deviceatlas-separator
1001 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001002 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001003 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001005 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001007 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001010 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001011 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001012 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001013 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001014 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001018 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001019 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001020 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001021 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001022 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001023 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001024 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001026 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001027 - presetenv
1028 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001029 - uid
1030 - ulimit-n
1031 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001032 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001033 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001034 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001035 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001038 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - ssl-default-bind-options
1040 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001041 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - ssl-default-server-options
1043 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001044 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001045 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001046 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001047 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001048 - 51degrees-data-file
1049 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001050 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001051 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001055 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001056 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001059 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001060 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001063 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001064 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001066 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001067 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001068 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001069 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 - noepoll
1071 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001072 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001074 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001075 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001076 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001077 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001078 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001079 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001080 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001081 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001082 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001083 - tune.buffers.limit
1084 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001085 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001087 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001088 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001089 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001090 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001091 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001092 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001093 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001094 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001095 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001096 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001097 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1099 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001100 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001101 - tune.maxaccept
1102 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001103 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001104 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001105 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001106 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1107 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001108 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1109 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001110 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001111 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001112 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001113 - tune.sndbuf.client
1114 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001115 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001116 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001117 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001118 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001119 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001120 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001121 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001122 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1123 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001124 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001125 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001126 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1127 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001129 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1130 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001134 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135
1136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011373.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138------------------------------------
1139
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001140ca-base <dir>
1141 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001142 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1143 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1144 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001145
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146chroot <jail dir>
1147 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1148 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1149 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1150 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1151 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001152 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001153
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001154cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001155 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001156 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1157 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1158 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1159 set. These sets have the format
1160
1161 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1162
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001163 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1164 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001165 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001166 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001167 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1168 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001169 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1170 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1171 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1172 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1173 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1174 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1175 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1176 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1177 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1178 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001179
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001180 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1181 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1182 on the machine's word size.
1183
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001184 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001185 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1186 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1187 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1188 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1189 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1190 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001191
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001192 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1193 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1194 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1195 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001197 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001198 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1199 # first 4 CPUs
1200
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001201 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1202 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001203 # word size.
1204
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001205 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1206 # and so on.
1207 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1209 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1210
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001211 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1212 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1213 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1214 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001216 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1217 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1218 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001219
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001220crt-base <dir>
1221 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001222 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1223 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001224
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001225daemon
1226 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1227 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001228 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1229 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001230
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001231default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001232 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001233 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1234 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1235 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1236 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1237 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1238 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1239 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1240 not start with a slash ('/'):
1241 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1242 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1243
1244 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1245 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1246 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1247 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1248 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1249 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1250 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1251 each of them.
1252
1253 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1254 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1255 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1256 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1257 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1258 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1259 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1260 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1261
1262 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1263 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001264 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001265 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1266 made easily relocatable.
1267
1268 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1269 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1270 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1271 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1272 consistent across all configuration files.
1273
1274 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1275 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1276 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1277 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1278 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1279 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1280 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1281 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1282
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001283deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1284 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001285 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001286
1287deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001288 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001289 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1290
1291deviceatlas-separator <char>
1292 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1293 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1294
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001295deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001296 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1297 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1298 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001299
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001300expose-experimental-directives
1301 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1302 the config file will be rejected.
1303
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001304external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001305 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1306 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001307 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1308 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1309 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1310 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1311 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001312
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001313gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001314 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001315 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1316 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001317 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001318 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001319 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001320
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001321grace <time>
1322 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1323
1324 Arguments :
1325 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1326 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1327 soft-stop operation.
1328
1329 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1330 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1331 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1332 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1333 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1334 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1335 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1336 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1337 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1338
1339 Example:
1340
1341 global
1342 grace 10s
1343
1344 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1345 frontend ext-check
1346 bind :9999
1347 monitor-uri /ext-check
1348 monitor fail if { stopping }
1349
1350 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1351 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1352 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1353 SIGUSR1 signal.
1354
1355 Example:
1356
1357 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1358 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1359 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1360 frontend ext-check
1361 bind :9999
1362 monitor-uri /ext-check
1363 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1364
1365 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1366
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001367group <group name>
1368 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1369 See also "gid" and "user".
1370
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001371hard-stop-after <time>
1372 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1373
1374 Arguments :
1375 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1376 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1377 SIGUSR1 signal.
1378
1379 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1380 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1381 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1382
1383 Example:
1384 global
1385 hard-stop-after 30s
1386
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001387 See also: grace
1388
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001389h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1390 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1391 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1392 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1393 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001394 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001395 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1396 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1397 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1398 specified in a proxy.
1399
1400 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1401 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1402 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1403 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1404 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1405 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1406 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1407
1408 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1409 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1410 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1411 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1412 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1413
1414 Example:
1415 global
1416 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1417
1418 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1419 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1420
1421h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1422 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1423 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1424 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1425 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1426 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1427 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1428 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1429 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1430
1431 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1432 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1433 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1434
1435 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1436 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1437
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001438insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001439 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001440 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1441 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1442 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1443 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1444 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1445 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1446 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001447 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001448 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1449 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1450 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1451 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1452 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1453 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1454 disable it.
1455
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001456insecure-setuid-wanted
1457 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1458 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1459 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1460 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001461 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001462 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001463 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001464 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1465 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001466 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001467 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1468 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1469 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1470 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1471
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001472issuers-chain-path <dir>
1473 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1474 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1475 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001477 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1478 "issuers-chain-path".
1479 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1480 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1481 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1482 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1483 will share the chain in memory.
1484
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001485h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1486 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1487 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1488 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1489 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1490 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1491 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1492 the keyword with "no'.
1493
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001494localpeer <name>
1495 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1496 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1497 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1498 the configuration parsing.
1499
1500 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1501 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1502
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001503log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001504 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001505 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001507 configured with "log global".
1508
1509 <address> can be one of:
1510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1513 port).
1514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1517 port).
1518
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001519 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001522 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001523
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001524 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1525 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1526 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1527 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1528 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1529 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1530 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1531 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1532 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1533 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001534 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001535 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1536 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1537 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001538 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1539 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001540
1541 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1542 "fd@2", see above.
1543
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001544 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1545 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1546 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1547 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1548 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1549
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001550 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1551 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001552
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001553 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1554 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1555 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1556 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1557 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1558 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1559 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1560 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1561 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1562 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001563 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1564 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001565
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001566 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1567 one of the following :
1568
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001569 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1570 field is stripped. This is the default.
1571 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1572 rfc3164.
1573
1574 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001575 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1576
1577 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1579
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001580 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1581 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1582 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1583 designed to be used with a local log server.
1584
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001585 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1586 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1587 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1588 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1589 logger consumes.
1590
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001591 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1592 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1593 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1594 used with a local log server.
1595
1596 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1597 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1598 designed to be used with a local log server.
1599
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001600 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1601 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1602 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1603 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1604
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001605 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1606 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1607 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1608 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1609 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1610
1611 <sample_size>
1612 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1613 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1614 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1615 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1616 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1617
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001618 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001619
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001620 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1621 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1622 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1623
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001624 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1625 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1626 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1627 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001628
1629 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001630 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1631 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1632 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1633 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1634 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1635 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001636
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001637 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001638
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001639log-send-hostname [<string>]
1640 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1641 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1642 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1643 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1644 the logs.
1645
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001646log-tag <string>
1647 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1648 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1649 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001650 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001651
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001652lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001653 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1654 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1655 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1656 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1657 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1658 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001659 used multiple times.
1660
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001661lua-load-per-thread <file>
1662 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1663 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1664 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1665 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1666 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1667 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1668 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1669 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1670 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1671 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1672 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1673 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1674 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1675 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1676 times.
1677
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001678lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1679 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1680 variable.
1681 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1682 to "path".
1683
1684 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1685 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1686 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1687 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1688 will be checked earlier.
1689
1690 As an example by specifying the following path:
1691
1692 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1694
1695 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1696 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1698 paths if that does not exist either.
1699
1700 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1701 documentation.
1702
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001703master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001704 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1705 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1706 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001707 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001708 or daemon mode.
1709
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001710 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1711 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1712 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1713 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1714 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001715
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001716 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001717
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001718mworker-max-reloads <number>
1719 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001720 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001721 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1722 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1723 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1724
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001725nbthread <number>
1726 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001727 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1728 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1729 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1730 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1731 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1732 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1733 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001734
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001735numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001736 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001737 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1738 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1739 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1740 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1741 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1742 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1743 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1744 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001746pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001747 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1748 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1749 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1750 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001751
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001752pp2-never-send-local
1753 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1754 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1755 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1756 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1757 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1758 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1759 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1760 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1761 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1762 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1763 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1764
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001765presetenv <name> <value>
1766 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1767 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1768 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1769 and "unsetenv".
1770
1771resetenv [<name> ...]
1772 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1773 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1774 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1775 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1776 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1777 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1778 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1779 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1780
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001781stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001782 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1783 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1784 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001785
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001786server-state-base <directory>
1787 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001788 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1789 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001790
1791server-state-file <file>
1792 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1793 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1794 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1795 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1796 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1797 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1798 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1799 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001800 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1801 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001802
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001803set-var <var-name> <expr>
1804 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1805 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1806 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1807 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1808 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1809 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001810 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001811 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1812 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1813
1814 Example:
1815 global
1816 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1817 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1818 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1819
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001820set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1821 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1822 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1823 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1824 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1825 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1826 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1827 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1828 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1829 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1830 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1831
1832 Example:
1833 global
1834 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1835 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1836
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001837setenv <name> <value>
1838 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1839 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1840 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1841 and "unsetenv".
1842
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001843set-dumpable
1844 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001845 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1846 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1847 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1848 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1849 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1850 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1851 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1852 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1853 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1854 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1855 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1856 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1857 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1858 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1859 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001860 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001861 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001862
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001863ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1865 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001866 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001867 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001868 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1869 information and recommendations see e.g.
1870 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1871 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1872 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1873 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001874
1875ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1877 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1878 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1879 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1880 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001881 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1882 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1883 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001884 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001885
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001886ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1888 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1889 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1890 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1891 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1892
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001893ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1895 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1896 keyword to see available options.
1897
1898 Example:
1899 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001900 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001901
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001902ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1904 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001905 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001906 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001907 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1908 information and recommendations see e.g.
1909 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1910 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1911 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1912 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1913 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001914
1915ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1917 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1918 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1919 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1920 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001921 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1922 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1923 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1924 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001925
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001926ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1928 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1929 keyword to see available options.
1930
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001931ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1932 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1933 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1934 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001935 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001936 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001937 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1938 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1939 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1940 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001941 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1942 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1943 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1944
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001945ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1946 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1947 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001948 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001949 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001950 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1951
1952 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001953
1954 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1955 and won't try to remove them.
1956
1957 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1958
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001959ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001960 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1962 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1963 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001964
1965 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1966 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1967 optimize the startup time.
1968
1969 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1970 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1971 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1972
1973 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001974 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001975
1976 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001977 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1978 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001979
1980 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1981 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1982 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1983 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1984 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001985 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001986
1987 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001988 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001989 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1990 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1991 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1992 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1993 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001994 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001995
1996 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1997
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001998 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001999 a cert bundle.
2000
2001 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2002 separately in several "crt".
2003
2004 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2005 since files are loading separately.
2006
2007 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2008 required to commit them.
2009
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002010 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002011 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002013 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2014 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2015 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002016
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002017 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2018 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2019 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002020
2021 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002022 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2023 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002024
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002025 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2026 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2027
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002028 The default behavior is "all".
2029
2030 Example:
2031 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2032 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2033 ssl-load-extra-files none
2034
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002035 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2036 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002037
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002038ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2039 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2040 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2041 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2042
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002043ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002044 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002045 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2046 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2047 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2048 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2049 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2050 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002051 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002052
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002053stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2054 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2055 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2056 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002057 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002058 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002059
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002060 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2061 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2062 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002063
2064stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2065 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2066 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002067 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002068
2069stats maxconn <connections>
2070 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2071 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2072
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002073thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2074 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2075 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2076 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2077 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2078 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2079 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2080 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2081 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2082 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2083
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002084thread-groups <number>
2085 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2086 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2087 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2088
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002089uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002090 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002091 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2092 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2093 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2094
2095ulimit-n <number>
2096 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2097 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2098 option.
2099
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002100 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2101 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2102 manually specify this value.
2103
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002104unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2105 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2106
2107 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2108 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2109 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2110 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2111 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002112 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002113 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2114 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2115 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2116 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2117
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002118unsetenv [<name> ...]
2119 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2120 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2121 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2122 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2123 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2124 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2125 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2126
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002127user <user name>
2128 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2129 See also "uid" and "group".
2130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002131node <name>
2132 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2133
2134 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2135 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2136 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2137 traffic.
2138
2139description <text>
2140 Add a text that describes the instance.
2141
2142 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2143 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2144 "<" and ">" characters.
2145
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100214651degrees-data-file <file path>
2147 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002148 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002149
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002150 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002151 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2152
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000215351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002154 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2155 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2156 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2157
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002158 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002159 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2160
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200216151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002162 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2163 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2164
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002165 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002166 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2167
216851degrees-cache-size <number>
2169 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2170 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2171 By default, this cache is disabled.
2172
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002173 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002174 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2175
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002176wurfl-data-file <file path>
2177 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2178 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2179
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002180 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002181 with USE_WURFL=1.
2182
2183wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2184 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2185 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2186 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2187
2188 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2189
2190 Valid WURFL properties are:
2191 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2192
2193 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2194 device.
2195
2196 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2197 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2198
2199 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2200 particular web request.
2201
2202 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2203 used Libwurfl API version.
2204
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002205 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2206 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2207
2208 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2209 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2210
2211 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2212
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002213 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002214 with USE_WURFL=1.
2215
2216wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2217 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2218 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2219
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002220 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002221 with USE_WURFL=1.
2222
2223wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2224 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2225 thus before the chroot.
2226
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002227 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002228 with USE_WURFL=1.
2229
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002230wurfl-cache-size <size>
2231 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2232 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002233 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002234 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002235
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002236 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002237 with USE_WURFL=1.
2238
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002239strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002240 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002241 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2242 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002243 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002244 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022463.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002247-----------------------
2248
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002249busy-polling
2250 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2251 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2252 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2253 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2254 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2255 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2256 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2257 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2258 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2259 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2260 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2261 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2262 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2263 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2264 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2265 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2266 "poll" pollers.
2267
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002268 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2269 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2270 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2271
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002272max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002273 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002274 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2275 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2276 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2277 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2278 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2279 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2280 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2281
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002282maxconn <number>
2283 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2284 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2285 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002286 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2287 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2288 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2289 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002290 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2291 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2292 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2293 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2294 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2295 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002296
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002297maxconnrate <number>
2298 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2299 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2300 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2301 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2302 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2303 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2304 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2305 fairness.
2306
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002307maxcomprate <number>
2308 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002309 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002310 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2311 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2312 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002314 default value.
2315
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002316maxcompcpuusage <number>
2317 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2318 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2319 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002320 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2321 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2322 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2323 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002324
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002325maxpipes <number>
2326 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2327 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2328 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2329 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2330 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2331 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2332
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002333maxsessrate <number>
2334 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2335 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2336 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2337 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2338 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2339 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2340 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2341 fairness.
2342
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002343maxsslconn <number>
2344 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2345 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2346 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2347 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2348 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2349 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2350 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002351 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2352 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2353 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2354 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002355 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002356 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2357 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002358
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002359maxsslrate <number>
2360 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2361 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2362 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2363 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2364 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2365 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2366 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2367 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2368 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2369 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2370
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002371maxzlibmem <number>
2372 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2373 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2374 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002375 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2376 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2377 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2378
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002379noepoll
2380 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2381 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002382 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002383
2384nokqueue
2385 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2386 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2387 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2388
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002389noevports
2390 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2391 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2392 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2393 also "nopoll".
2394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002395nopoll
2396 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2397 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002399 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2400 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002401
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002402nosplice
2403 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002404 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002405 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002406 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002407 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2408 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2409 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2410 "option splice-response".
2411
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002412nogetaddrinfo
2413 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2414 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2415
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002416noreuseport
2417 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2418 command line argument "-dR".
2419
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002420profiling.memory { on | off }
2421 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2422 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2423 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2424 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2425 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2426 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2427 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2428 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2429 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2430
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002431profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2432 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2433 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2434 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2435 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002436 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002437 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2438 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2439 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2440 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2441
2442 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2443 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2444 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2445 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2446 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002447 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2448 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2449 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2450 CLI.
2451
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002452spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002453 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2454 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2455 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2456 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2457 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2458 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002460ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002461 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002462 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002463 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002464 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002465 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2466 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2467 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002468 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2469 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002470 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2471 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2472 openssl configuration file uses:
2473 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2474
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002475ssl-mode-async
2476 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002477 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002478 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2479 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002480 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002481 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002482 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002483
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002484tune.buffers.limit <number>
2485 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2486 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2487 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2488 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2489 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002490 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002491 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2492 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2493 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2494 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2495 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2496 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2497 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2498 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002499 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002500
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002501tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2502 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2503 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2504 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002505 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002506
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002507tune.bufsize <number>
2508 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2509 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2510 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2511 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2512 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2513 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2514 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002515 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2516 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002518 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002519 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002520 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2521 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002522
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002523tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2524 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2525 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2526 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2527 this value. The default value is 1.
2528
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002529tune.fail-alloc
2530 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2531 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2532 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2533 gracefully.
2534
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002535tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2536 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2537 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2538 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2539 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2540 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2541
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002542tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2543 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2544 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2545 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2546 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2547 change it.
2548
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002549tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2550 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002551 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002552 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002553 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2554 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2555 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2556 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2557 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2558
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002559tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2560 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2561 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2562 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2563 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2564 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002565 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002566 recommended not to change this value.
2567
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002568tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002569 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002570 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002572 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2573 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2574 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2575 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2576
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002577tune.http.cookielen <number>
2578 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2579 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2580 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2581 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2582 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2583 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2584 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2585 to change this value.
2586
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002587tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002588 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2589 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002590 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002591 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002592 configuration directives too.
2593 The default value is 1024.
2594
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002595tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2596 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2597 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2598 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2599 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2600 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2601 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002602 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2603 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2604 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002605
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002606tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2607 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2608 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2609 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2610 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2611 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2612 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002613 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2614 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2615 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2616 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2617 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002618
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002619tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002620 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002621 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2622 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2623 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2624 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002625 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002626 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002627 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002628 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2629
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002630tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2631 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2632 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2633 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2634 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2635 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2636 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2637 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2638 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2639 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2640
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002641tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2642 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002643 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002644 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2645 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002646 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002647 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2648 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2649
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002650tune.lua.maxmem
2651 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2652 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2653 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2654 memory.
2655
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002656tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2657 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002658 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2659 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002660 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002661
2662tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2663 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2664 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2665 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2666 check servers.
2667
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002668tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2669 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2670 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2671 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002672 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002673
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002674tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002675 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2676 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002677 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2678 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2679 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2680 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2681 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2682 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2683 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2684 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2685 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002686
2687tune.maxpollevents <number>
2688 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2689 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2690 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2691 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2692 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2693
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002694tune.maxrewrite <number>
2695 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2696 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2697 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2698 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2699 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2700 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2701 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2702 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2703 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2704 bufsize.
2705
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002706tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2707 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2708 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2709 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2710 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2711 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2712 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2713 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2714 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2715 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002716 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2717 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002718 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2719 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2720 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2721 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2722 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2723 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2724 setting this parameter to 0.
2725
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002726tune.pipesize <number>
2727 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2728 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2729 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2730 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2731 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2732 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2733
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002734tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2735 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002736 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002737 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2738 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2739 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2740 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002741 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002742
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002743tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2744 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002745 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002746 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2747 default is 20.
2748
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002749tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2750tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2751 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2752 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2753 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002754 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002755 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002756 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2757 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2758
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002759tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002760 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002761 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2762 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2763 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2764 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2765
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002766tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002767 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002768 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2769 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2770 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2771 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2772 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2773 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2774 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002775
2776tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2777 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002778 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002779 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2780 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2781 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2782 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2783 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2784 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2785 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002786
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002787tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2788tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2789 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2790 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2791 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002792 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002793 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002794 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2795 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2796 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2797 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002798 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002799
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002800tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002801 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002802 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2803 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2804 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2805 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2806 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2807 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2808 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2809 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2810 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002811 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2812 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002813
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002814tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002815 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002816 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2817 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2818 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2819 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2820 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2821
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002822tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2823 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2824 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2825 performances. This is disabled by default.
2826
2827 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2828 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2829
2830 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2831
2832 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2833
2834 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2835
2836 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2837 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2838 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2839
2840 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2841 converted.
2842
2843 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2844 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2845 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2846 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2847 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2848 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2849 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002850 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2851 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002852
2853 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2854
2855 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2856 only need this line:
2857
2858 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2859
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002860tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2861 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002862 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002863 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2864 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2865 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2866 being used for too long.
2867
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002868tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2869 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2870 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2871 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2872 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2873 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2874 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2875 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2876 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2877 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2878 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002879 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002880 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002881
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002882tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2883 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2884 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2885 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2886 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002887 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002888 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2889 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002890 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2891 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002892
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002893tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2894 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2895 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2896 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2897 1000 entries.
2898
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002899tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2900tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002901 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2902 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2903 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2904 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002905
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002906tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002907tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002908tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2909tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2910tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002911 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2912 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2913 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2914 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2915 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2916 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2917 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2918 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002919
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002920 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2921 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2922 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2923 all available space is consumed.
2924 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2925 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2926 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002927
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002928tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2929 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002930 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002931 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002932 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002933 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2934
2935tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2936 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2937 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002938 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2939 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029413.3. Debugging
2942--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002944quiet
2945 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2946 line argument "-q".
2947
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002948zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002949 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002950 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2951 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2952 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2953 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2954 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2955
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029573.4. Userlists
2958--------------
2959It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2960http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2961it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2962
2963userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002964 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002965 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2966
2967group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002968 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002969 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2970 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2971
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002972user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2973 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002974 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2975 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002976 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2977 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2978 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2979 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002980
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002981 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2982 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2983 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2984 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2985 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2986 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2987 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002988 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002989 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002990
2991 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002992 userlist L1
2993 group G1 users tiger,scott
2994 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002995
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002996 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2997 user scott insecure-password elgato
2998 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002999
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003000 userlist L2
3001 group G1
3002 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003003
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003004 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3005 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3006 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003007
3008 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003009
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003010
30113.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003012----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003013It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003014several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003015instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003016values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3017type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3018values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3019active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3020switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3021present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3022watch it.
3023
3024Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3025known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3026the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3027process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3028during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3029tables.
3030
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003031Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3032that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3033each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003034
3035peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003036 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003037 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3038
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003039bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3040 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3041 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3042
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003043disabled
3044 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3045 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3046 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3047
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003048default-bind [param*]
3049 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3050
3051default-server [param*]
3052 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3053
3054 Arguments:
3055 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3056 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3057 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3058 details.
3059
3060
3061 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3062
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003063enabled
3064 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3065 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003066
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003067log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003068 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3069 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3070 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3071 more details.
3072
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003073peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003074 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3075 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003076 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003077 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003078 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3079 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3080 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003081
3082 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3083 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3084
3085 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003086 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3087 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3088 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003089
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003090 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3091 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003093 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3094 "server" keyword explanation below).
3095
3096server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003097 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003098 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3099 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3100 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3101 of this "peers" section).
3102 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3103
3104
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003105 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003106 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003107 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003108 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3109 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3110 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003111
3112 backend mybackend
3113 mode tcp
3114 balance roundrobin
3115 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3116 stick on src
3117
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003118 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3119 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003120
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003121 Example:
3122 peers mypeers
3123 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3124 default-server ssl verify none
3125 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3126 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003127
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003128
3129table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3130 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3131
3132 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3133 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003134 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003135 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3136 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3137 "stick-table" keyword).
3138
3139 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3140 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3141 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3142 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3143 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3144 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3145 of the stick-table name as follows:
3146
3147 peers mypeers
3148 peer A ...
3149 peer B ...
3150 table t1 ...
3151
3152 frontend fe1
3153 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3154
3155 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3156 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3157
3158 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3159 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3160 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3161 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3162 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3163 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3164 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3165
3166 peers mypeers
3167 peer A ...
3168 peer B ...
3169 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3170
3171 backend t1
3172 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3173
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003174 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003175 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3176 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3177
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031783.6. Mailers
3179------------
3180It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3181If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3182in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3183
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003184mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003185 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3186 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3187
3188mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3189 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3190
3191 Example:
3192 mailers mymailers
3193 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3194 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3195
3196 backend mybackend
3197 mode tcp
3198 balance roundrobin
3199
3200 email-alert mailers mymailers
3201 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3202 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3203
3204 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3205 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3206
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003207timeout mail <time>
3208 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3209 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3210 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3211 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3212
3213 Example:
3214 mailers mymailers
3215 timeout mail 20s
3216 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003217
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020032183.7. Programs
3219-------------
3220In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3221master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3222managed the same way as the workers.
3223
3224During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3225sequence as a worker:
3226
3227 - the master is re-executed
3228 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3229 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3230 instance of the program
3231
3232During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3233
3234program <name>
3235 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3236 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3237 the management guide).
3238
3239command <command> [arguments*]
3240 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3241 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3242 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3243 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3244
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003245user <user name>
3246 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3247 See also "group".
3248
3249group <group name>
3250 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3251 See also "user".
3252
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003253option start-on-reload
3254no option start-on-reload
3255 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3256 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3257 program section.
3258
3259
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032603.8. HTTP-errors
3261----------------
3262
3263It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3264imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3265several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3266
3267http-errors <name>
3268 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3269 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3270
3271errorfile <code> <file>
3272 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3273
3274 Arguments :
3275 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003276 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003277 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003278
3279 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3280 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3281 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3282 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3283 before any chroot is performed.
3284
3285 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3286
3287 Example:
3288 http-errors website-1
3289 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3290 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3291 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3292
3293 http-errors website-2
3294 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3295 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3296 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3297
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032983.9. Rings
3299----------
3300
3301It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3302servers or traces.
3303
3304ring <ringname>
3305 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3306
3307description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003308 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003309 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3310
3311format <format>
3312 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3313
3314 Arguments:
3315 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3316 one of the following :
3317
3318 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3319 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3320 designed to be used with a local log server.
3321
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003322 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3323 field is stripped. This is the default.
3324 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3325 rfc3164.
3326
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003327 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3328 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3329 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3330 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3331 is the default.
3332
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003333 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003334 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3335
3336 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3337 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3338
3339 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3340 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3341 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3342 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3343 logger consumes.
3344
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003345 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3346 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3347 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3348 with a local log server.
3349
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003350 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3351 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3352 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3353 used with a local log server.
3354
3355maxlen <length>
3356 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3357 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3358 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3359
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003360server <name> <address> [param*]
3361 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3362 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3363 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3364 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3365 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3366 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3367 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3368 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3369 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003370 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3371 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003372
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003373size <size>
3374 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3375 set to BUFSIZE.
3376
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003377timeout connect <timeout>
3378 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3379
3380 Arguments :
3381 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3382 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3383 as explained at the top of this document.
3384
3385timeout server <timeout>
3386 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3387
3388 Arguments :
3389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3391 as explained at the top of this document.
3392
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003393 Example:
3394 global
3395 log ring@myring local7
3396
3397 ring myring
3398 description "My local buffer"
3399 format rfc3164
3400 maxlen 1200
3401 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003402 timeout connect 5s
3403 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003404 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003405
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020034063.10. Log forwarding
3407-------------------
3408
3409It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003410HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411
3412log-forward <name>
3413 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3414
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003415backlog <conns>
3416 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3417 on connections accept.
3418
3419bind <addr> [param*]
3420 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003421 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3422 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3423 syslog protocol over TCP.
3424 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003425 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3426
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003427dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003428 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3429 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3430 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3431 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003432 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433
3434log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003435log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003436 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3437 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3438 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003439 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003440 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3441 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3442 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003443 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003444
3445 Example:
3446 global
3447 log stderr format iso local7
3448
3449 ring myring
3450 description "My local buffer"
3451 format rfc5424
3452 maxlen 1200
3453 size 32764
3454 timeout connect 5s
3455 timeout server 10s
3456 # syslog tcp server
3457 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3458
3459 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003460 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3461 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003462 # all messages on stderr
3463 log global
3464 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3465 log ring@myring local0
3466 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3467 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3468 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3469 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3470 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003471
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003472maxconn <conns>
3473 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3474 10 is the default.
3475
3476timeout client <timeout>
3477 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003480----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003482Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003483 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3484 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3485 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3486 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003487
3488A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3489connections.
3490
3491A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3492to forward incoming connections.
3493
3494A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3495parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3496
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003497A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3498ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3499sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3500the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3501explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3502from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3503"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3504for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3505to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3506optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3507are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3508any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3509names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3510that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3511duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3512names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3513
3514Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3515settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3516of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3517profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3518timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3521'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3522case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3523
3524Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3525logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3526proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3527However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3528name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3529
3530Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3531and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003532bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3534modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3535arbitrary criteria.
3536
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003537In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3538a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003539the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003540
3541 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3542 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3543 between responses and new requests.
3544
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003545 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3546 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3547 client-facing connection remains open.
3548
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003549 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3550 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003551
3552The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3553frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3554following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003555weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003556
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003557 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003558
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003559 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3560 ----+-----+-----+----
3561 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3562 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003563 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3564 ----+-----+-----+----
3565 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003566
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003567It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003568only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3569within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003570as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003571content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003572and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3573possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003575There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003576first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003577processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003578second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003579protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3580is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3581new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003582to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003583process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3584already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3585HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3586evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3587one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3588
3589There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3590performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3591tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3592preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3593analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3594HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3595header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3596mitigate this drawback.
3597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003598There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003599method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3600set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3601in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3602is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3603to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3604above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3605to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3606"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3607frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3608frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3609as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3610upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3611on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3612the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3613upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3614frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3615remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036174.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3618--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003620The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3621limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3622they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3623limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003624marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003625option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003626and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3627with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3628specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003630
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3632------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3633acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634backlog X X X -
3635balance X - X X
3636bind - X X -
3637bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003638capture cookie - X X -
3639capture request header - X X -
3640capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003641clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3642clitcpka-idle X X X -
3643clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003644compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003646declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003647default-server X - X X
3648default_backend X X X -
3649description - X X X
3650disabled X X X X
3651dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003652email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003653email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003654email-alert mailers X X X X
3655email-alert myhostname X X X X
3656email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657enabled X X X X
3658errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003659errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660errorloc X X X X
3661errorloc302 X X X X
3662-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3663errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003664error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003665force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003666filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003668hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003669http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003670http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003671http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003672http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003673http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003674http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003675http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003676http-check set-var X - X X
3677http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003678http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003679http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003680http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003681http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003682http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003683id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003684ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003685load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003686log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003687log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003688log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003689log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003690max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691maxconn X X X -
3692mode X X X X
3693monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003694monitor-uri X X X -
3695option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3696option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3697option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3698option allbackups (*) X - X X
3699option checkcache (*) X - X X
3700option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3701option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003702option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003703option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3704option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3706option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003707option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3708option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003709option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003710option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003711option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003712option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003713option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003714option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3715option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3716option httpchk X - X X
3717option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003718option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003719option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003720option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003721option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003722option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3724option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3725option logasap (*) X X X -
3726option mysql-check X - X X
3727option nolinger (*) X X X X
3728option originalto X X X X
3729option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003730option pgsql-check X - X X
3731option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003732option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003733option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003734option smtpchk X - X X
3735option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3736option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3737option splice-request (*) X X X X
3738option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003739option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003740option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3741option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3742-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003743option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3745option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3746option tcpka X X X X
3747option tcplog X X X X
3748option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003749external-check command X - X X
3750external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003751persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3752rate-limit sessions X X X -
3753redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003754-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003755retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003756retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003757server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003758server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003759server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003760source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003761srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3762srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3763srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003764stats admin - X X X
3765stats auth X X X X
3766stats enable X X X X
3767stats hide-version X X X X
3768stats http-request - X X X
3769stats realm X X X X
3770stats refresh X X X X
3771stats scope X X X X
3772stats show-desc X X X X
3773stats show-legends X X X X
3774stats show-node X X X X
3775stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003776-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3777stick match - - X X
3778stick on - - X X
3779stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003780stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003781stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003782tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003783tcp-check connect X - X X
3784tcp-check expect X - X X
3785tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003786tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003787tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003788tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003789tcp-check set-var X - X X
3790tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003791tcp-request connection - X X -
3792tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003793tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003794tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003795tcp-response content - - X X
3796tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003797timeout check X - X X
3798timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003799timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003800timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003801timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3802timeout http-request X X X X
3803timeout queue X - X X
3804timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003805timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003806timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003807timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003808transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003809unique-id-format X X X -
3810unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003811use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003812use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003813use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003814------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3815 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3819---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003820
3821This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3822
3823
3824acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3825 Declare or complete an access list.
3826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 no | yes | yes | yes
3828 Example:
3829 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3830 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3831 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003833 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834
3835
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003836backlog <conns>
3837 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | no
3840 Arguments :
3841 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3842 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003843 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003844
3845 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3846 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3847 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3848 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3849 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3850 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3851 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3852 backlog parameter.
3853
3854 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3855 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3856 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3857
3858 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3859
3860
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003861balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003862balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | no | yes | yes
3866 Arguments :
3867 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3868 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3869 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3870 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3871
3872 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3873 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3874 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3875 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003876 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003877 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003878 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3879 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3880 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3881 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3882 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3883 it, so that you don't worry.
3884
3885 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3886 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3887 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3888 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3889 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3890 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3891 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3892 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003893
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003894 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3895 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3896 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3897 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3898 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3899 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3900 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003901 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3902 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3903 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003904
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003905 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003906 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003907 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3908 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003909 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003910 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3911 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3912 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3913 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3914 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003915 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3916 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3917 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3918 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3919 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3920 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3923 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3924 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3925 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3926 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3927 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3928 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3929 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003930 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003932 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3933 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3934 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003936 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3937 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3938 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3939 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3940 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3941 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3942 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3943 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3944 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3945 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3946 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3947 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003948
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003949 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003950 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3951 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3952 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3953 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3954 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3955 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3956 URIs start with a leading "/".
3957
3958 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3959 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3960 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3961 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3962
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003963 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3964 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3965 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3966 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003969 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3970
3971 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003972 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3973 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003974 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3975 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3976 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3977 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003978 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003979 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3980 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3983 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3984 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3985 server will receive the request.
3986
3987 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3988 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3989 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3990 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3991 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003992 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3993 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3994 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003995
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003996 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3997 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3998 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3999 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4000 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004002 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004003 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4004 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4005 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4006
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004007 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4008 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4009 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4010
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004011 random
4012 random(<draws>)
4013 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004014 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4015 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4016 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4017 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004018 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4019 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4020 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4021 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4022 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4023 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4024 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4025 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4026 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4027 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4028 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4029 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4030 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4031 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4032 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4033 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4034 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4035 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4036 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4037 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004038
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004039 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004040 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004041 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4042 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
4043 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
4044 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4045 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4046 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004047 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004048 used instead.
4049
4050 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4051 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4052 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
4053 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
4054
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004055 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4056 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4057 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4058
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004059 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004061 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004062 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4063 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004064
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004065 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4066 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4067 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004068
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004069 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004070 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004071 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4072 NTLM relies on.
4073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004074 Examples :
4075 balance roundrobin
4076 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004077 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004078 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4079 balance hdr(host)
4080 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004081
4082 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4083 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004085 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004086 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4087 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4088 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004089 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004090
4091 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4092 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4093 defaults to 16 kB.
4094
4095 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4096 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4097
4098 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4099 Round Robin.
4100
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004101 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004102 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4103 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4104 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4105
4106 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4107
4108 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004109 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004110 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4111 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4112 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004114 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115
4116
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004117bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4118bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004119 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4121 no | yes | yes | no
4122 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004123 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4124 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4125 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4126 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004127 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004128 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4129 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4130 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4131 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4132 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4133 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004134 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004135 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4136 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004137 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004138 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4139 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004140 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004141 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4142 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004143 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004144 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004145 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4146 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4147 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004148 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4149 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4150 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4151 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004152 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4153 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4154 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004155
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004156 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4157 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004158 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4159 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4160 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004161 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4162 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4163 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4164 the range.
4165
4166 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4167 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4168 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4169 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4170 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4171 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4172 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004173 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004174 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004176 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004177 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004178 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4179 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4180 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4181 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4182 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4183 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004185 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4186 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4187 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4188 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004189
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004190 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4191 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4192 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4193 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4194 in a frontend.
4195
4196 Example :
4197 listen http_proxy
4198 bind :80,:443
4199 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004200 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004201
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004202 listen http_https_proxy
4203 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004204 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004205
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004206 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4207 bind ipv6@:80
4208 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4209 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4210
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004211 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004212 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004213
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004214 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4215 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4216 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4217 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4218 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4219
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004220 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004221 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004222
4223
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004224bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4226 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004227
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004228 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4229 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4230 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4231 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4232 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4233 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004234
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004235 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004236
4237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238capture cookie <name> len <length>
4239 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 no | yes | yes | no
4242 Arguments :
4243 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4244 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4245 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4246 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004247 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004248
4249 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4250 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4251 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4252 right if it exceeds <length>.
4253
4254 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4255 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4256 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4257 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4258
4259 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4260 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4261 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4262
4263 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4264 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4265 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004266 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4267 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4268 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004269
4270 Example:
4271 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4272
4273 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004274 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004275
4276
4277capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004278 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4280 no | yes | yes | no
4281 Arguments :
4282 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004283 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004284 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4285 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4286 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4287
4288 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4289 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4290 it exceeds <length>.
4291
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004292 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004293 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4294 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004295 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4296 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4297 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4298 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004299 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004300 environments to find where the request came from.
4301
4302 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4303 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4304 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4305 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004307 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4308 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4309 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4310 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4311 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004312
4313 Example:
4314 capture request header Host len 15
4315 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004316 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004318 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004319 about logging.
4320
4321
4322capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004323 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 no | yes | yes | no
4326 Arguments :
4327 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004328 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004329 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4330 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4331 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4332
4333 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4334 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4335 it exceeds <length>.
4336
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004337 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004338 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4339 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4340 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004341 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4342 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4343 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4344 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004346 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4347 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4348 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4349 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4350 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004351
4352 Example:
4353 capture response header Content-length len 9
4354 capture response header Location len 15
4355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004356 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004357 about logging.
4358
4359
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004360clitcpka-cnt <count>
4361 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4362 the connection on the client side.
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | yes | yes | no
4365 Arguments :
4366 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4367
4368 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4369 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004370 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4371 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004372
4373 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4374
4375
4376clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4377 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4378 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4379 client side.
4380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | yes | yes | no
4382 Arguments :
4383 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4384 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4385 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4386 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4387
4388 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4389 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004390 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4391 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004392
4393 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4394
4395
4396clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4397 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | yes | yes | no
4400 Arguments :
4401 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4402 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4403 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4404 document.
4405
4406 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4407 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004408 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4409 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004410
4411 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4412
4413
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004414compression algo <algorithm> ...
4415compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004416compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004417 Enable HTTP compression.
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 yes | yes | yes | yes
4420 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004421 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4422 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004423 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004424
4425 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004426 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4427 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4428 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004429
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004430 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004431 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004432
4433 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4434 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4435 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4436 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4437 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004438 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004439
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004440 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4441 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4442 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4443 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4444 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4445 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4446 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004447 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004448
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004449 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004450 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004451 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004453 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004454 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004455 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004456
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004457 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004458 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4459 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4461 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004462 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004463 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004464 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4465 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004467 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4468 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004469
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004470 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004471 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4472 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004473 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004474 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004475 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4476 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4477 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4478 "multipart"
4479 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4480 header
4481 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4482 and later
4483 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4484 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004485 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004486
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004487 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004488
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004489 Examples :
4490 compression algo gzip
4491 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004492
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004493
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004494cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004495 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4496 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004497 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004498 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4500 yes | no | yes | yes
4501 Arguments :
4502 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4503 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4504 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4505 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4506 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4507 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004508 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004509 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4510 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4511
4512 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004513 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004514 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4515 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4516 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4517 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004518 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4519 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004520 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004521 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4522 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004523
4524 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004525 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004526
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004527 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004528 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004529 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004530 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004531 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4532 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4533 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4534 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4535 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4536 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4537 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538
4539 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4540 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4541 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4542 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4543 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4544 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4545 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4546 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4547 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004548 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004549 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4550 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4551 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004553 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4554 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4555 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004556 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4557 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4558 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4559 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004560 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4561 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4562 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004563
4564 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4565 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4566 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4567 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4568 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4569 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4570 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4571 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4572 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4573
4574 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4575 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4576 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4577 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4578 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4579 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4580 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4581 persistence cookie in the cache.
4582 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4583
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004584 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4585 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004586 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004587 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4588 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004589 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004590 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4591 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4592 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4593 they logout.
4594
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004595 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004596 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4597 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4598 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4599
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004600 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004601 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4602 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4603 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4604 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4605 this attribute.
4606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004607 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004608 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004609 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4610 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4611 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4612 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4613 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4614 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004615
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004616 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4617 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4618 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4619 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4620 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4621 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4622 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4623 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004624 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004625 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4626 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4627 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4628 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4629 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4630 the site.
4631
4632 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4633 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4634 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4635 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4636 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4637 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4638 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4639 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4640 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4641 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4642 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4643 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4644 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004645 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004646 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4647 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4648
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004649 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4650 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4651 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4652 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4653 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4654 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4655
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004656 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004657 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4658 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4659 repeated.
4660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004661 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4662 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4663 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4664 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004665
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004666 Examples :
4667 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4668 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4669 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004670 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004671
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004672 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004674
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004675declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4676 Declares a capture slot.
4677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4678 no | yes | yes | no
4679 Arguments:
4680 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4681
4682 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4683 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4684 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4685 for use in the response.
4686
4687 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004688 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004689 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4690
4691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004692default-server [param*]
4693 Change default options for a server in a backend
4694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4695 yes | no | yes | yes
4696 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004697 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4698 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4699 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4700 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004701
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004702 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004703 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4704
4705 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004706
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708default_backend <backend>
4709 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 yes | yes | yes | no
4712 Arguments :
4713 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4714
4715 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4716 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4717 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4718 will catch all undetermined requests.
4719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720 Example :
4721
4722 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4723 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4724 default_backend dynamic
4725
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004726 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004728
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004729description <string>
4730 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4732 no | yes | yes | yes
4733 Arguments : string
4734
4735 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4736 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4737 it describes.
4738 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4739
4740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004741disabled
4742 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4744 yes | yes | yes | yes
4745 Arguments : none
4746
4747 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4748 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4749 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4750 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4751 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4752 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4753 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4754
4755 See also : "enabled"
4756
4757
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004758dispatch <address>:<port>
4759 Set a default server address
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004762 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004763
4764 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4765 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4766 during start-up.
4767
4768 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4769 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4770 possible with normal servers.
4771
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004772 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004773 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4774 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4775 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4776 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4777
4778 See also : "server"
4779
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004780
4781dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4782 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 yes | no | yes | yes
4785 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4786
4787 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004788 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004789 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4790 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004792 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004794enabled
4795 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | yes | yes | yes
4798 Arguments : none
4799
4800 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4801 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4802
4803 See also : "disabled"
4804
4805
4806errorfile <code> <file>
4807 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | yes | yes | yes
4810 Arguments :
4811 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004812 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004813 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004814
4815 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004816 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004818 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4819 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004820
4821 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4822 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4823 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4824
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004825 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4826
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004827 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4828 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4829 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4830 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4831 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4832 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4833 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4834 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4835 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004837 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4838 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4839 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004840 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004841 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4842
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004843 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004845 Example :
4846 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004847 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4849 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4850
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004851
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004852errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4853 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4854 section.
4855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | yes | yes | yes
4857 Arguments :
4858 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4859
4860 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004861 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004862 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4863 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004864
4865 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4866 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4867 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4868 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4869 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004870 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004871 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4872
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004873 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4874 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004875
4876 Example :
4877 errorfiles generic
4878 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4879
4880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004881errorloc <code> <url>
4882errorloc302 <code> <url>
4883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | yes
4886 Arguments :
4887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004888 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004889 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004890
4891 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4892 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4893 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4894 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004895 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004896
4897 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4898 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4899 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004901 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004903 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4904 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4905 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4906 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004907 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004908 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4909 request.
4910
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004911 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004912
4913
4914errorloc303 <code> <url>
4915 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4917 yes | yes | yes | yes
4918 Arguments :
4919 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004920 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004921 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004922
4923 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4924 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4925 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4926 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004927 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004928
4929 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4930 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4931 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4932
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004933 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004935 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4936 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4937 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4938 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004939 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004940
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004941 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942
4943
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004944email-alert from <emailaddr>
4945 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004946 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4948 yes | yes | yes | yes
4949
4950 Arguments :
4951
4952 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4953
4954 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4955 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004957 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004958 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4959 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004960
4961
4962email-alert level <level>
4963 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4964 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | yes | yes | yes
4967
4968 Arguments :
4969
4970 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4971 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4972 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4973
4974 By default level is alert
4975
4976 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4977 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4978 for the proxy.
4979
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004980 Alerts are sent when :
4981
4982 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4983 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4984 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4985 is notice or lower
4986 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4987 and a health check status update occurs
4988
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004989 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4990 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004991 section 3.6 about mailers.
4992
4993
4994email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4995 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | yes | yes | yes
4998
4999 Arguments :
5000
5001 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5002
5003 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5004 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5005
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005006 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5007 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005008
5009
5010email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5011 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5012 mailers.
5013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | yes | yes | yes
5015
5016 Arguments :
5017
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005018 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005019
5020 By default the systems hostname is used.
5021
5022 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5023 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5024 for the proxy.
5025
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005026 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5027 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005028
5029
5030email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005031 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005032 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5034 yes | yes | yes | yes
5035
5036 Arguments :
5037
5038 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5039
5040 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5041 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5042
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005043 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005044 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5045
5046
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005047error-log-format <string>
5048 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5050 yes | yes | yes | no
5051
5052 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5053 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5054 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5055 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
5056 connection errors described in section 8.2.6..
5057 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5058 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5059 string in depth.
5060
5061 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5062 directives.
5063
5064
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005065force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5066 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005068 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005069
5070 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5071 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5072 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5073 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5074 marked down for maintenance operations.
5075
5076 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5077 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5078 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5079 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5080 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5081 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5082 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5083 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5084 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5085
5086 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5087 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5088 is used.
5089
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005090 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005091 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005092
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005093
5094filter <name> [param*]
5095 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5097 no | yes | yes | yes
5098 Arguments :
5099 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5100 referenced in section 9.
5101
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005102 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005103 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005104 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5105 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005106
5107 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5108 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5109
5110 Example:
5111 listen
5112 bind *:80
5113
5114 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5115 filter compression
5116 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5117
5118 compression algo gzip
5119 compression offload
5120
5121 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5122
5123 See also : section 9.
5124
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005126fullconn <conns>
5127 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5129 yes | no | yes | yes
5130 Arguments :
5131 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5132 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5133
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005134 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005136 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5138 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5139 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5140 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5141 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005142 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005143
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005144 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005145 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005146 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5147 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5148 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005150 Example :
5151 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5152 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5153 # connections.
5154 backend dynamic
5155 fullconn 10000
5156 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5157 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5158
5159 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5160
5161
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005162hash-balance-factor <factor>
5163 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5165 yes | no | no | yes
5166 Arguments :
5167 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5168 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005169 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005170
5171 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5172 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5173 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5174 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5175 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5176 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5177 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5178
5179 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5180 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5181 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5182 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5183 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5184
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005185 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5186 consistent hashing mechanism.
5187
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005188 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5189
5190
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005191hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005192 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 yes | no | yes | yes
5195 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005196 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5197 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005198
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005199 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5200 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5201 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5202 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5203 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5204 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5205 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5206 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5207 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5208 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005209
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005210 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5211 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5212 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5213 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5214 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5215 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5216 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5217 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5218 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5219 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5220 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5221 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5222 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005223 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5224 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005225
5226 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005228 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5230 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5231 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005232 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5233 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5234 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005235
5236 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5237 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005238 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5239 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5240 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5241 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005243 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005244 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5245 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5246 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5247 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5248 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5249 parameter.
5250
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005251 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5252 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5253 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5254 used on strings.
5255
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005256 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5257
5258 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5259 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5260 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5261 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5262 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5263 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5264 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5265 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5266 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5267 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5268 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5269 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005270
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005271 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5272 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5273 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005274
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005275 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005276
5277
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005278http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5279 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5280 ones).
5281
5282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 no | yes | yes | yes
5284
5285 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5286 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5287 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5289 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5290 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5291
5292 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5293 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5294 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5295
5296 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5297 below.
5298
5299 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5300 instance.
5301
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005302 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5303 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5304 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5305
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005306 Example:
5307 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5308 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5309 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5310
5311http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5312
5313 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5314 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5315 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5316 example, or to pass some internal information.
5317 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5318 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5319 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5320
5321http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322
5323 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5324 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5325
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005326http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005327
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005328 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5329 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5330 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5331 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5332 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005333
5334http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5336
5337 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5338
5339 Example:
5340 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5341
5342 # applied to:
5343 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5344
5345 # outputs:
5346 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5347
5348 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5349
5350http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5351 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5352
5353 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5354
5355 Example:
5356 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5357
5358 # applied to:
5359 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5360
5361 # outputs:
5362 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5363
5364http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5365
5366 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5367 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5368 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5369
5370http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5371 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5372
5373 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5374 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5375 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5376 fallback.
5377
5378 Example:
5379 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5380 http-response set-status 431
5381 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5382 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5383
5384http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005385http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005386 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5387 inline.
5388
5389 Arguments:
5390 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5391 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5392 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5393 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5394 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5395 (request and response)
5396 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5397 processing
5398 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5399 processing
5400 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5401 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5402 and '_'.
5403
5404 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5405 followed by some converters.
5406
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005407 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5408 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5409
5410 Examples:
5411 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5412 http-after-response set-var-fmt(sess.last_be_addr) %[bi]:%[bp]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005413
5414http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5415
5416 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5417 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5418 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5419 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5420 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005421 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 processing.
5423
5424 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5425 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005426 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427 rules evaluation.
5428
5429http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5432 details about <var-name>.
5433
5434 Example:
5435 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5436
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005437
5438http-check comment <string>
5439 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5440 it fails.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | no | yes | yes
5443
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005444 Arguments :
5445 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5446 rule fails.
5447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005448 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5449 user-friendly error reporting.
5450
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005451 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 "http-check expect".
5453
5454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5456 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005457 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005462 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5464
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005466 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467
5468 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5469 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5470 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5471 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5472
5473 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5474
5475 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5476
5477 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5478
5479 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5480
5481 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5482
5483 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5484 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5485 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5486 is used.
5487
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005488 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5489 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5490 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5491 haproxy -vv.
5492
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5496 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5497 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5498 different ports or with different servers.
5499
5500 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5501 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5502 the port with a "http-check connect".
5503
5504 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5505 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5506 do.
5507
5508 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5509 unset-var or comment rules.
5510
5511 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5513 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5514 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5515 option httpchk
5516
5517 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005518 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005519 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005521 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005522 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523
5524 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5525
5526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529http-check disable-on-404
5530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5546 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5547 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005549 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550
5551
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005552http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5554 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5555 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005556 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005559
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005561 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5562
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005563 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5564 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5565 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5566 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5567 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5568 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5569 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5570 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5571 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5572 result is always conclusive.
5573
5574 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5576 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005577 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5578 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005579 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5580 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005581 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5582 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5583 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005584
5585 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5586 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005587 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5588 supported :
5589 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5590 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005591 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5592 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5593 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5594 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5595 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005596
5597 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5598 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005599 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5600 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5601 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5602 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5604
5605 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5607 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5608 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5609
5610 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5611 informational message reported in logs if an error
5612 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5613 log-format string.
5614
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005616 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5617 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5619 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5620 details on the supported keywords.
5621
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005622 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5623 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5624 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5625 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
5627 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5628 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5629 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5630 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5631 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5632
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005633 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5634 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5635 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5636 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5637 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5638 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5639 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640
5641 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5644 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5645 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5646 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5647
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005648 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5649 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005650 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5651 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5652 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5653 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5654 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5655 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5656 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5657 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005658 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5659 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5660 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5661 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5662 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5663 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5664 insensitive on the header names.
5665
5666 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5667 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5668 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5669 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5670 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5671 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005672
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005673 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005674 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5676 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5677 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5678 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5679 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005680 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005681 trace).
5682
5683 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5686 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5687 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5688 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5689 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005690 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005691
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005692 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5694 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5695 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5696 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5697 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005700 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5702 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5703 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5704 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5705 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5706 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5707
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5709 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5710 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5711 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5712 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005713
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5715 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5716
5717 Examples :
5718 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005719 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005721 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5722 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5723
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005725 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726
5727 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005728 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729
5730 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005731 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005734 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735
5736
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005737http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005738 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5739 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005740 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5741 health checks.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005745 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5746
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5748 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5749 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5750 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5751 to invent non-standard ones.
5752
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005753 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5755 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5756 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5757
5758 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5759 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5760 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5761 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005762
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005763 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005764 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005765 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5767 to add it.
5768
5769 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5770 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5771 to the log-format rules.
5772
5773 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5774 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5775 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005777 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5779 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5780 request.
5781
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005782 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5783 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5784 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005785 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5786 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5787 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5788 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005789 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005790
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005792 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5793 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005794
5795 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5796 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5797 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5798 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5799 configured request authority.
5800
5801 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5802 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005804 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005805
5806
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807http-check send-state
5808 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811 Arguments : none
5812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005813 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005814 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005815 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5816 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5817 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005818
5819 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5820 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5821 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5822 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5823 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005824 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5825 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5826 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5827
5828 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5829 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5830 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5831
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5833 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5834 checked in multiple backends.
5835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005836 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005837 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5838
5839 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5840 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5841 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5842 one fails.
5843
5844 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5845 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5846 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5847
5848 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5849 server's queue.
5850
5851 Example of a header received by the application server :
5852 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5853 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005855 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5856 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005858
5859http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005860http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 yes | no | yes | yes
5864
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005865 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005866 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5867 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5868 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5869 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5870 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5871 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5872 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5873 and '-'.
5874
5875 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5876
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005877 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5878 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5879
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005880 Examples :
5881 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005882 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005883
5884
5885http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | no | yes | yes
5889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005890 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5892 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5895 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5897 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5898 and '-'.
5899
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005900 Examples :
5901 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005904http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5905 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5906 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5907 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5908 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | yes | yes | yes
5911 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005912 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005913 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005914 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005915 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005916
5917 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5918 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5919 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5920 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5921
5922 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5923 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5924 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5925 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5926
5927 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5928 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5929 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5930 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5931 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5932 chroot is performed.
5933
5934 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5935 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5936 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5937 considered.
5938
5939 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5940 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5941 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5942 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5943 considered as a raw string.
5944
5945 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5946 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5947 "content-type".
5948
5949 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5950 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5951 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5952 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5953 evaluated as a log-format string.
5954
5955 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5956 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5957 argument to "content-type".
5958
5959 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5960 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5961 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5962 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5963
5964 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5965 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5966 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5967 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5968 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5969 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5970 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5971 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5972
5973 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5974 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5975 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5976
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005977 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5978 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5979 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5980 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5981 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5982
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005983 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5984 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5985
5986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005987http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005988 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5989
5990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 no | yes | yes | yes
5992
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005993 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5994 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5995 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5996 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5997 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6000 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 Example:
6005 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6006 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6007 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 http-request allow if nagios
6010 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6011 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6012 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 Example:
6015 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6016 acl add path /addacl
6017 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6022 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 Example:
6025 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6026 acl setmap path /setmap
6027 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6032 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6035 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006037http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006039 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6040 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6041 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6042 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6043 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6044 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6045 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6046 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6051 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6052 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6053 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6054 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6055 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6056 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6057 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6062 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006063
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6068 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6069 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6070 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6071 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006072
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006073 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6074 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6075 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6076 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6077 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6078 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6079 instead.
6080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081 Example:
6082 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6083 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006084
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006085http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006086
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006087 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6093 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6094 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6095 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6096 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6097 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6098 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6099 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6100 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6103 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6104 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006105 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6106
6107 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6108 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6109 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6110 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6115 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6116 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6117 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6118 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6119 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006120
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006121http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006122
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006123 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6124 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6125 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6126 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6127 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006131 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6134 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6135 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6136 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006137
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006138http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6139http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6140 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6141 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6142 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6143 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006144
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006145 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6146 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6147 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006148 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006149 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6150 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6151 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006153 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006154
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006155http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6157 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6158 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6159
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006160http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6161
6162 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6163 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6164 pointed by <resolvers>.
6165 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6166 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6167 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6168 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6169 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6170 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6171 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6172 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6173 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6174 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6175 to 0.0.0.0.
6176
6177 Example:
6178 resolvers mydns
6179 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6180 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6181 timeout retry 1s
6182 hold valid 10s
6183 hold nx 3s
6184 hold other 3s
6185 hold obsolete 0s
6186 accepted_payload_size 8192
6187
6188 frontend fe
6189 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6190 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6191 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6192
6193 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6194 # which mean DNS resolution error
6195 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6196
6197 default_backend be
6198
6199 backend b_503
6200 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6201 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6202 # 503 error page to end users
6203
6204 backend be
6205 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6206 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6207 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6208 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6209 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6210
6211 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6212 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6213
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006214http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6215
6216 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6217 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6218 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6219 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006220 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6221 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006222
6223 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6224
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006225http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006226http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006227http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006229http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006230http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006231http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006232http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6233http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006234
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006235 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6236
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006237 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006238 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6239 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6240 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6241 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006242
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006243 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6244 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6245 the supported backend.
6246
6247 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6248 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6249 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6250 number of segments in the path.
6251
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006252 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6253 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6254 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6255 when improperly combined.
6256
6257 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6258 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6259 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6260 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6261 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6262
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006263 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006264
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006265 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6266
6267 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6268 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6269
6270 Example:
6271 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6272
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006273 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6274
6275 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6276 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6277
6278 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6279 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6280
6281 Example:
6282 - /#foo -> /
6283
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006284 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6285 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006286
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006287 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6288 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6289
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006290 Example:
6291 - /. -> /
6292 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6293 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6294 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006295
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006296 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6297 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6298
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006299 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006300 their preceding segment.
6301
6302 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6303 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6304
6305 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6306 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006307
6308 Example:
6309 - /foo/../ -> /
6310 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6311 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6312 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006313 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006314 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006315 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006316
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006317 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6318 removed as well:
6319
6320 Example:
6321 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6322 - /bar/../../ -> /
6323
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006324 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6325 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006326
6327 Example:
6328 - // -> /
6329 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6330
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006331 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6332 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6333
6334 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6335 ".", "_", and "~".
6336
6337 Example:
6338 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6339 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6340 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6341 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6342
6343 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6344 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6345
6346 Example:
6347 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6348 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6349
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006350 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006351 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006352
6353 Example:
6354 - /%6f -> /%6F
6355 - /%zz -> /%zz
6356
6357 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6358 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6359
6360 Example:
6361 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6362
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006363 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006364 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6365 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6366
6367 Example:
6368 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6369 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6370 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006374 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6375 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6376 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6377 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6378 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006382 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6383 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6384 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6385 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006387http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6388 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006389
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006390 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006391 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6392 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6393 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6394 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6395 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006396
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006397 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6398 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6399 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6400 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6401 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006402
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006403 Example:
6404 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6405
6406 # applied to:
6407 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6408
6409 # outputs:
6410 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6411
6412 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006413
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006414 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6415
6416 # applied to:
6417 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006418
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006419 # outputs:
6420 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006421
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006422http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6424
6425 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6426 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006427 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6428 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6429 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006430
6431 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6432 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6433 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6434
6435 Example:
6436 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6437 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6438
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006439 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6440 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6441 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6442 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6443
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006444http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446
6447 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6448 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6449 query-string are replaced.
6450
6451 Example:
6452 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6453 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6454
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006455http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6456 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006458 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6459 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6460 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6461 against.
6462
6463 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6464 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6465 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006466
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006467 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6468 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6469 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6470 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6471 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6472 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6473 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6474 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6475 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006476 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6477 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006479 Example:
6480 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6481 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006482
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006483 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6484 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6487 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006488
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006489 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6490 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6491 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6492 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006493
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006494 Example:
6495 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006496
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006497 # applied to:
6498 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006499
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006500 # outputs:
6501 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006502
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006503http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6504 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6505 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006506 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6508
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006509 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006510 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6511 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006512 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006513 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006514 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006515 are followed to create the response :
6516
6517 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6518 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6519 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6520 ignored.
6521
6522 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6523 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006524 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006525 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6526 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006527
6528 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6529 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6530 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006531 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006532 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006533
6534 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6535 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6536 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006537 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006538 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006539 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006540
6541 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6542 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6543 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6544 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6545 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6546 as a raw content.
6547
6548 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6549 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6550 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6551 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6552 considered as a raw string.
6553
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006554 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006555 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6556 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6557 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6558
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006559 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6560 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006561 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006562
6563 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6564
6565 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006566 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006567 if { path /ping }
6568
6569 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6570 if { path /favicon.ico }
6571
6572 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6573 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6574 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6575
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006576http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6577
6578 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6579 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6580 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6581 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6582 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6583 at this index.
6584 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6585 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6588http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6591 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6592 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006593
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006594http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6595 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6596 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6597 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6598 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6599 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6600 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6601 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6602 at this index.
6603 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6604 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6605
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006606http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6607 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006608
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006609 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6610 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6611 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6612 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6617 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6618 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6619 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6620 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006622 Arguments:
6623 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6624 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 Example:
6627 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6628 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6631 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6636 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6637 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 Arguments:
6640 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6641 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643 Example:
6644 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6645 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6648 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6649 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6654 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6655 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6656 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6657 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 Example:
6660 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6661 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6662 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6663 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6664 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6665 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6666 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6667 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6668 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006672 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6673 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6674 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6675 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6676 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6682 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6683 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6684 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6685 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6686 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6687 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6688 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6689 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006692
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006693 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6694 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6695 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6696 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6697 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6698 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6699 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006700 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6701 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006703http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6706 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6707 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6712 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6713 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6714 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6715 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6716 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6717 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6718 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6723 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6724 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6725 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6726 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6727 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 Example :
6730 # prepend the host name before the path
6731 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006732
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006733http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6734
6735 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6736 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6737 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6742 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6743 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6744 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6745 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6750 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6751 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6752 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6753 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6754 values have higher priority.
6755 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6756 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6757 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6758 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6759 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006761http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006763 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6764 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6765 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6766 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6767 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6768 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6769 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006772
6773 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6775 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6778 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6779 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6780 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006781 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6782 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006783
6784 Arguments :
6785 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6786 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006787
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006788 See also "option forwardfor".
6789
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006790 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006791 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6792 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6793
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006794 # After the masking this will track connections
6795 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6796 http-request track-sc0 src
6797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006798 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6799 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6800
6801http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6802
6803 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6804 expression.
6805
6806 Arguments:
6807 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6808 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006809
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006810 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6812 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6813
6814 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6815 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6816 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6817
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006818http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820
6821 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6822 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6823 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6824 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6825 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6826
6827 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6828 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6829 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6830 results.
6831
6832 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006833 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6834 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006836http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6837
6838 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6839 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6840 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6841 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6842 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6843 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6844 information from the request.
6845
6846 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6847
6848http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6849
6850 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6851 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6852 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6853 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6854 path and the query string.
6855 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6856
6857http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006858http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859
6860 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6861 inline.
6862
6863 Arguments:
6864 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6865 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6866 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6867 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6868 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6869 (request and response)
6870 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6871 processing
6872 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6873 processing
6874 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6875 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6876 and '_'.
6877
6878 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6879 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006880
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006881 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6882 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6883
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006884 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006885 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006886 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
6887
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006889http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6890 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006892 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6893 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6894 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6895 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6896 agent name must be used.
6897
6898 Arguments:
6899 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6900
6901 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6902 configuration.
6903
6904http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6905
6906 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6907 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6908 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6909 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6910 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6911 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6912 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6913 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6914 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6915 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6916 action.
6917 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6918 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6919 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6920 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6921 you fully understand how it works.
6922
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006923http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6924
6925 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6926 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6927 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6928 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6929 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006930 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006931 processing.
6932
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006933 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006934 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6935 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6936 rules evaluation.
6937
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006938http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6939http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6940 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6941 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6942 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6943 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006944
6945 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6946 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6947 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006948 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6949 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6950 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6951 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6952 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6953 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006954 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006955 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6956 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6957 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006958 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006959 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6960 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6961 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6962 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6963 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006964
6965http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6966http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6967http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6968
6969 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6970 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6971 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6972 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006973 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006974 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6975 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6976 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6977 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6978 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6979 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6980 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6981
6982 Arguments :
6983 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6984 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6985 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6986 select which table entry to update the counters.
6987
6988 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6989 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6990 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6991 that table until the session ends.
6992
6993 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6994 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6995 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6996 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6997 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6998 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6999 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7000 useful information.
7001
7002 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7003 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7004 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7005 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7006 checks that make use of it.
7007
7008http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7009
7010 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007011
7012 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007013 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007014
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007015http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7016
7017 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7018 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7019 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7020 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7021 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7022 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7023
7024 Arguments :
7025 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7026
7027 Example:
7028 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7029
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007030http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7031 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7032
7033 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7034 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7035 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7036 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7037 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7038 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7039 http-buffer-request".
7040
7041 Arguments :
7042
7043 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7044 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7045
7046 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007047 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007048 bytes.
7049
7050 Example:
7051 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7052
7053 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007055http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007057 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7058 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7059 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007060
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007062http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007063 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7064
7065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7066 no | yes | yes | yes
7067
7068 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7069 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7070 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7071 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7072 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7073 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7076 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 Example:
7081 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7086 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007088 Example:
7089 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7094 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7097 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007099http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007101 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7102 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7103 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7104 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7105 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7106 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7107 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7108 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007112 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7113 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7114 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7115 example, or to pass some internal information.
7116 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7117 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7118 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007120http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7123 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007124
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007125http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007126
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007127 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007129http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007131 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7132 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7133 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7134 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7135 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7136 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7137 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007139 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7140 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7141 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7142 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7143 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007144
7145 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7146 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7147 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7148 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007150http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007152 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7153 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7154 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7155 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7156 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7157 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007158
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007159http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007160
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007161 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7162 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7163 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7164 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7165 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007169 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7170 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7171 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7172 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7173 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7174 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007175
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007176http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7177http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7178 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7179 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7180 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7181 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007182
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007183 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7184 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7185 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007186 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007187 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7188 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7189 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007190 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007191 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007193http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7196 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7197 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7198 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7199 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7200 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007202http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007204
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007205 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7206 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007208 Example:
7209 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007211 # applied to:
7212 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007214 # outputs:
7215 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007217 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007219http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7220 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007221
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007222 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007223 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007225 Example:
7226 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007228 # applied to:
7229 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007231 # outputs:
7232 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007233
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007234http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7235 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7236 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007237 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007238 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7239
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007240 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007241 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7242 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007243 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007244 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007245 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007246 are followed to create the response :
7247
7248 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7249 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7250 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7251 ignored.
7252
7253 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7254 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007255 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007256 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7257 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258
7259 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7260 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7261 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007262 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007263 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007264
7265 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7266 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7267 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007268 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007269 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007270 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007271
7272 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7273 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7274 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7275 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7276 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7277 as a raw content.
7278
7279 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7280 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7281 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7282 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7283 considered as a raw string.
7284
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007285 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7286 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7287 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7288 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7289
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007290 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7291 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007292 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007293
7294 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7295
7296 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007297 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007298 if { status eq 404 }
7299
7300 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7301 string "This is the end !" \
7302 if { status eq 500 }
7303
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007304http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7305
7306 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7307 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7308 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7309 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7310 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7311 at this index.
7312 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7313 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7316http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007317
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007318 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7319 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7320 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007321
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007322http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7324
7325 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7326 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7327 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7328 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7329 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7330 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7331 at this index.
7332 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7333 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7334
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007335http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7336 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007337
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007338 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7339 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7340 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7341 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007342
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007343http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7344 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007346 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7347 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7348 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7349 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7350 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007352 Arguments:
7353 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7356 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007357
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007358http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7361 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7362 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007363
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007364http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7365
7366 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7367 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7368 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7369 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7370 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7371
7372http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7373
7374 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7375 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7376 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7377 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7378 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7379 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7380 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7381 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7382 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7383
7384http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7385
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007386 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7387 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7388 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7389 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7390 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7391 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7392 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007393 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7394 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007395
7396http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7397
7398 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7399 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7400 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7401 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7402 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7403 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7404 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7405 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7406
7407http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7409
7410 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7411 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7412 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7413 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007414
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007415 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007416 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7417 http-response set-status 431
7418 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7419 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007421http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007423 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7424 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7425 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7426 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7427 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7428 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7429 based on some information from the request.
7430
7431 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7432
7433http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007434http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007435
7436 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7437 inline.
7438
7439 Arguments:
7440 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7441 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7442 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7443 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7444 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7445 (request and response)
7446 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7447 processing
7448 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7449 processing
7450 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7451 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7452 and '_'.
7453
7454 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7455 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007456
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007457 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7458 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7459
7460 Examples:
7461 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
7462 http-response set-var-fmt(sess.last_be_addr) %[bi]:%[bp]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007464http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007466 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7467 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7468 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7469 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7470 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7471 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7472 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7473 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7474 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7475 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7476 action.
7477 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7478 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7479 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7480 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7481 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007482
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007483http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7484
7485 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7486 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7487 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7488 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7489 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007490 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007491 processing.
7492
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007493 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007494 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007495 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007496 rules evaluation.
7497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007498http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7499http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7500http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007501
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007502 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7503 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7504 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7505 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7506 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007507 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007508
7509http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7510
7511 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7512 about <var-name>.
7513
7514 Example:
7515 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7516
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007517http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7518 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7519
7520 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7521 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7522 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7523 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7524 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7525 buffer is full.
7526
7527 Arguments :
7528
7529 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7530 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7531
7532 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007533 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007534 bytes.
7535
7536 Example:
7537 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007538
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007539http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7540 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7541
7542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7543 yes | no | yes | yes
7544
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007545 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007546 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7547 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7548 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007549
7550 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7551
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007552 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7553 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7554 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7555 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7556 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7557 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7558 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007559 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007560 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7561 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007562
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007563 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7564 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7565 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7566 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7567 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7568 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7569 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007570 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7571 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7572 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7573 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7574 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7575 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007576
7577 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7578 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7579 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7580 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7581 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7582 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7583 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7584 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007585 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007586 downsides of rare connection failures.
7587
7588 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7589 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7590 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7591 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7592 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7593 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007594 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007595 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7596 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7597 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7598 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7599 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7600
7601 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007602 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7603 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7604 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7605 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007606
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007607 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7608 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007609
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007610 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007611
7612 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7613 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7614 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7615
7616 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7617
7618
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007619http-send-name-header [<header>]
7620 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7622 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007623 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007624 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7625
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007626 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7627 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7628 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7629 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7630 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7631 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7632 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7633 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7634 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7635 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7636 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7637 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7638 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7639 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7640 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7641 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007642
7643 See also : "server"
7644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007645id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007646 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7648 no | yes | yes | yes
7649 Arguments : none
7650
7651 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7652 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7653 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007654
7655
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007656ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7657 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007659 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007660
7661 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7662 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7663 and running).
7664
7665 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7666 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7667 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007668 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007669 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7670
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007671 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7672 "unless" condition is met.
7673
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007674 Example:
7675 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7676 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7677 ignore-persist if url_static
7678
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007679 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7680
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007681load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7682 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7684 yes | no | yes | yes
7685
7686 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7687 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7688 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007689 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007690 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007691 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7692 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7693 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7694
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007695 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007696 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007697 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007698
7699 Arguments:
7700 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7701 named "server-state-file".
7702
7703 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7704 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7705 name is used as a file name.
7706
7707 none don't load any stat for this backend
7708
7709 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007710 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7711 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7712 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007713 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007714 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007715
7716 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7717 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7718
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007719 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007720
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007721 global
7722 stats socket /tmp/socket
7723 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007724
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007725 defaults
7726 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007727
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007728 backend bk
7729 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7730 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007731
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007732
7733 Then one can run :
7734
7735 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7736
7737 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7738
7739 1
7740 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7741 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7742 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7743
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007744 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007745
7746 global
7747 stats socket /tmp/socket
7748 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7749
7750 defaults
7751 load-server-state-from-file local
7752
7753 backend bk
7754 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7755 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7756
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007757
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007758 Then one can run :
7759
7760 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7761
7762 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7763
7764 1
7765 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7766 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7767 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7768
7769 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7770 "show servers state"
7771
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007772
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007773log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007774log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007775 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007776no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007777 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007780
7781 Prefix :
7782 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7783 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7784 prefix does not allow arguments.
7785
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007786 Arguments :
7787 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7788 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7789 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7790 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7791 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7792 parameter.
7793
7794 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7795 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7796
7797 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7798 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7799 standard syslog port).
7800
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007801 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7802 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7803 standard syslog port).
7804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007805 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7806 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7807 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007808 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007809
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007810 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7811 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7812 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7813 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7814 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7815 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7816 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7817 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7818 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7819 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7820 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7821 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007822 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007823 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7824 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7825 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007826 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7827 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007828
7829 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7830 and "fd@2", see above.
7831
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007832 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7833 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7834 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7835 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7836 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7837 having the logs instantly available.
7838
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007839 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7840 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7841 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7842
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7844 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007845
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007846 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7847 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7848 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7849 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7850 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7851 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7852 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7853 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7854 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7855 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007856 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007857
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007858 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7859 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7860 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7861 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7862 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7863
7864 <sample_size>
7865 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7866 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7867 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7868 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7869 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7870
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007871 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7872 one of the following :
7873
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007874 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7875 field is stripped. This is the default.
7876 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7877 rfc3164.
7878
7879 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007880 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7881
7882 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7883 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7884
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007885 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7886 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7887 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7888 designed to be used with a local log server.
7889
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007890 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7891 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7892 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7893 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7894 systemd logger consumes.
7895
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007896 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7897 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7898 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7899 used with a local log server.
7900
7901 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7902 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7903 designed to be used with a local log server.
7904
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007905 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7906 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7907 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7908 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007910 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7911
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007912 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7913 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7914 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7915
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007916 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7917 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7918 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7919 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007920
7921 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7922 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7923 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007924 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7925 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7926 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7927 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7928 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007929
7930 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7931
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007932 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7933 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7934 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007935
7936 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7937 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7938 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7939 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7940
7941 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7942 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007943
7944 Example :
7945 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007946 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7947 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7948 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007949 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007950 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7951 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007952 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007953
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007954
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007955log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007956 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007959
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007960 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7961 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7962 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7963 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7964 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007965 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7966 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007967
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007968 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7969 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007970
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007971log-format-sd <string>
7972 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | yes | yes | no
7975
7976 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7977 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7978 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7979 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7980 which covers the log format string in depth.
7981
7982 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7983 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7984
7985 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7986 log format to "rfc5424".
7987
7988 Example :
7989 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7990
7991
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007992log-tag <string>
7993 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 yes | yes | yes | yes
7996
7997 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7998 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007999 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008000 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8001 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8002 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8003 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8004 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8005 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008006
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008007max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8008 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8010 yes | no | yes | yes
8011
8012 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8013 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8014 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8015 servers.
8016
8017 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008018 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008019 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8020 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8021 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008022 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008023 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8024 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8025 picking a different server.
8026
8027 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8028 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8029 even if they have to be queued.
8030
8031 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8032 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8033
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008034max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8035 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8036 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8037 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008038
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008039maxconn <conns>
8040 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 yes | yes | yes | no
8043 Arguments :
8044 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8045 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8046 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8047 closes.
8048
8049 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008050 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008051 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8052 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008053 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8054 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8055 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8056 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008057
8058 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8059 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8060 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8061
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008062 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8063 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008064
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008065 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8066
8067
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008068mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008069 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8071 yes | yes | yes | yes
8072 Arguments :
8073 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8074 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8075 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8076 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8077
8078 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8079 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8080 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8081 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8082 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8083
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008084 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8085 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8086 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008088 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008089 defaults http_instances
8090 mode http
8091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008092
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008093monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008094 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8096 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008097 Arguments :
8098 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8099 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008100 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008101 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8102 backend and its backup.
8103
8104 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8105 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8106 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8107 servers in a list of backends.
8108
8109 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8110 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8111 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008112 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008113 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8114 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008115 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008116 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8117 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008118
8119 Example:
8120 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008121 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008122 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8123 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8124 monitor-uri /site_alive
8125 monitor fail if site_dead
8126
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008127 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008128
8129
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008130monitor-uri <uri>
8131 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 yes | yes | yes | no
8134 Arguments :
8135 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8136 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8137
8138 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8139 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8140 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8141 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8142 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8143 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8144 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8145 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8146
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008147 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008148 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8149 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8150 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8151 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8152 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8153 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008154
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008155 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8156 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8157 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8158 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8159
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008160 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008161 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008162 frontend www
8163 mode http
8164 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8165
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008166 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008168
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008169option abortonclose
8170no option abortonclose
8171 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8173 yes | no | yes | yes
8174 Arguments : none
8175
8176 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8177 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8178 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8179 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008180 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008181 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8182 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8183 encountered while delivering the response.
8184
8185 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8186 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8187 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8188 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8189 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8190 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008191 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008192 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008193 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008194 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8195 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8196 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8197
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008198 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8199 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008200 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8201 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8202 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8203 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8204 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8205 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008206 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008207
8208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8210
8211 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8212
8213
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008214option accept-invalid-http-request
8215no option accept-invalid-http-request
8216 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | yes | yes | no
8219 Arguments : none
8220
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008221 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008222 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008224 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8225 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8226 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8227 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8228 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008229 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8230 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8231 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8232 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008234 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008235 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8236 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8237 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008238
8239 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8240 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8241 been confirmed.
8242
8243 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8244 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008245 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8246 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008247 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8248
8249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8251
8252 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8253 stats socket.
8254
8255
8256option accept-invalid-http-response
8257no option accept-invalid-http-response
8258 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 yes | no | yes | yes
8261 Arguments : none
8262
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008263 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008264 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008266 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8267 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8268 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8269 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8270 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008271 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8272 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8273 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008274
8275 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8276 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8277 been confirmed.
8278
8279 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8280 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8281 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8282 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8283
8284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8286
8287 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8288 stats socket.
8289
8290
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008291option allbackups
8292no option allbackups
8293 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8295 yes | no | yes | yes
8296 Arguments : none
8297
8298 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8299 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8300 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8301 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8302 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8303 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8304 order between the backup servers anymore.
8305
8306 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8307 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8308
8309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8311
8312
8313option checkcache
8314no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008315 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8317 yes | no | yes | yes
8318 Arguments : none
8319
8320 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8321 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008322 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008323 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8324 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008325 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008326
8327 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008328 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008329 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008330 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8331 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008332 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008334 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8335 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008337 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8338 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008339 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008340 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8341 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8342 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8343 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8344 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8345 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8346 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8347 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8348 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8349
8350 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008351 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8352 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8353 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8354 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008355
8356 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8357 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008358 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008360
8361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8363
8364
8365option clitcpka
8366no option clitcpka
8367 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | yes | yes | no
8370 Arguments : none
8371
8372 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8373 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008374 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008375 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8376
8377 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8378 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8379 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8380 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8381
8382 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8383 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8384 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8385 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8386 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8387
8388 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8389
8390 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8391 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8392 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8393
8394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8396
8397 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8398
8399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008400option contstats
8401 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8403 yes | yes | yes | no
8404 Arguments : none
8405
8406 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8407 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8408 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008409 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008410 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8411 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8412 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8413 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8414 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008415
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008416option disable-h2-upgrade
8417no option disable-h2-upgrade
8418 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8419 connection.
8420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8421 yes | yes | yes | no
8422 Arguments : none
8423
8424 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8425 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8426 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8427 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008428 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8429 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8430 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8431 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8432 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8433 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008434
8435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008437
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008438option dontlog-normal
8439no option dontlog-normal
8440 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 yes | yes | yes | no
8443 Arguments : none
8444
8445 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8446 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8447 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8448 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8449 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8450 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8451 logged.
8452
8453 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8454 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8455 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008457 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008458 logging.
8459
8460
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008461option dontlognull
8462no option dontlognull
8463 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | yes | yes | no
8466 Arguments : none
8467
8468 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8469 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8470 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8471 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8472 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8473 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008474 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8475 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8476 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008477
8478 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008479 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008480 would not be logged.
8481
8482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8484
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008485 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008486 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008487
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008488
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008489option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008490 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 yes | yes | yes | yes
8493 Arguments :
8494 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8495 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008496 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008497 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008498
8499 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8500 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8501 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8502 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8503 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8504 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8505 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008506 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8507 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8508 possible that the client has already brought one.
8509
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008510 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008511 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008512 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008513 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008514 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008515 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008516
8517 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8518 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8519 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8520 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8521 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8522 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008523 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008524
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008525 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8526 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008527 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008528 are under the control of the end-user.
8529
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008530 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008531 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8532 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008533 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8534 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8535 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008536
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008537 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008538 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8539 frontend www
8540 mode http
8541 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8542
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008543 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8544 backend www
8545 mode http
8546 option forwardfor header X-Client
8547
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008548 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008549 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008550
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008551
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008552option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8553no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8554 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8556 yes | yes | yes | no
8557 Arguments : none
8558
8559 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8560 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8561 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8562 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8563 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8564 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8565 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8566
8567 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8568 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8569 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8570 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8571 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8572 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8573 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8574 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8575 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8576 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8577
8578 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8579
8580 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8581 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8582
8583 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8584 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8585
8586
8587option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8588no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8589 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8591 yes | no | yes | yes
8592 Arguments : none
8593
8594 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8595 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8596 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8597 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8598 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8599 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8600 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8601
8602 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8603 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8604 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8605 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8606 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8607 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8608 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8609 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8610 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8611 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8612
8613 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8614
8615 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8616 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8617
8618 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8619 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8620
8621
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008622option http-buffer-request
8623no option http-buffer-request
8624 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 yes | yes | yes | yes
8627 Arguments : none
8628
8629 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8630 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8631 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8632 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8633 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8634 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008635 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8636 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8637 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8638 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008639
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008640 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8641 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008642
8643
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008644option http-ignore-probes
8645no option http-ignore-probes
8646 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8648 yes | yes | yes | no
8649 Arguments : none
8650
8651 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8652 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8653 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8654 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8655 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8656 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8657 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8658 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8659 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008660 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8661 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008662 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8663
8664 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8665 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8666 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8667 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8668 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8669 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8670 are often the only way to detect them.
8671
8672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8674
8675 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8676
8677
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008678option http-keep-alive
8679no option http-keep-alive
8680 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8682 yes | yes | yes | yes
8683 Arguments : none
8684
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008685 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8686 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008687 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8688 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008689 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8690 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8691 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008692
8693 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8694 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008695 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8696 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8697 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8698 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8699 situations where this option may be useful :
8700
8701 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008703
8704 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8705 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8706
8707 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8708 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8709 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8710 request.
8711
8712 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8713 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008714 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8715 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8716 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008717
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008718 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8719 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8720 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8721 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8722 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8723 not set.
8724
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008725 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8726 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8727 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008728
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008729 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008730 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008731 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008732
8733
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008734option http-no-delay
8735no option http-no-delay
8736 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8738 yes | yes | yes | yes
8739 Arguments : none
8740
8741 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8742 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8743 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8744 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8745 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8746 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8747 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008748 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008749 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8750 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8751 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8752 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8753 affected.
8754
8755 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8756 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8757 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8758 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8759 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8760 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8761 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8762 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8763 latency environments.
8764
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008765 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8766
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008767
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008768option http-pretend-keepalive
8769no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008770 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008772 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008773 Arguments : none
8774
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008775 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008776 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8777 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8778 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008779 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008780 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8781 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8782 consider the response complete.
8783
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008784 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008785 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008786 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008787 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008788 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008789 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8790
8791 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8792 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8793 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8794 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008795 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8796 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008797 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8798
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008799 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8800 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8801 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8802 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8803 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8804 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008805
8806 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8807 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8808
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008809 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008810 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008811
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008812
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008813option http-server-close
8814no option http-server-close
8815 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8817 yes | yes | yes | yes
8818 Arguments : none
8819
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008820 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8821 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8822 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8823 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008824 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8825 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8826 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8827 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8828 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8829 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8830 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8831 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8832 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8833 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8834 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008835
8836 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8837 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8838 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8839 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008840 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8841 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008842
8843 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8844 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008845 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8846 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8847 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008848
8849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8851
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008852 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8853 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008854
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008855option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008856no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008857 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8859 yes | yes | yes | no
8860 Arguments : none
8861
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008862 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008863 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8864 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8865 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8866 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8867 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008868 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008869
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008870 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008871 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008872 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8873 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8874 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008875
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008876 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8877 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8878 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8879 front of an existing proxy.
8880
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008881 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8882
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008883 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008884
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008885option httpchk
8886option httpchk <uri>
8887option httpchk <method> <uri>
8888option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008889 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8891 yes | no | yes | yes
8892 Arguments :
8893 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8894 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8895 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8896 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8897 ones.
8898
8899 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8900 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8901 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8902
8903 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8904 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8905 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008906 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008907
8908 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8909 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8910 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8911 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8912 the lack of any response.
8913
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008914 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8915 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8916 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8917 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8918
8919 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8920 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8921 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008922
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008923 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8924 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008925 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008926 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008927 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008928
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008929 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8930 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8931 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8932 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8933
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008934 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008935 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8936 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8937 backend https_relay
8938 mode tcp
8939 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8940 http-check send hdr Host www
8941 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008942
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008943 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8944 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8945 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008946
8947
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008948option httpclose
8949no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008950 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8952 yes | yes | yes | yes
8953 Arguments : none
8954
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008955 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8956 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8957 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8958 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008959 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008960
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008961 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8962 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008963 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008964 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8965 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008966
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008967 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8968 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8969 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008970
8971 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8972 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008973 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8974 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8975 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008976
8977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8979
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008980 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008981
8982
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008983option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008984 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008986 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008987 Arguments :
8988 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8989 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8990 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008991 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008992 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008993
8994 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8995 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8996 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8997 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8998 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8999 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9000 ports.
9001
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009002 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9003 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009004
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009005 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009007 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009008
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009009option httpslog
9010 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9012 yes | yes | yes | no
9013
9014 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9015 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9016 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9017 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9018 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9019 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9020 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9021
9022 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9023
9024 See also : section 8 about logging.
9025
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009026
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009027option independent-streams
9028no option independent-streams
9029 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9031 yes | yes | yes | yes
9032 Arguments : none
9033
9034 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9035 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9036 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9037 receive data or not.
9038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009039 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009040 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9041 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9042 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9043 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9044 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9045 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9046 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9047 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9048 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9049 socket buffers.
9050
9051 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9052 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9053 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9054 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9055 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9056
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009057 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009058
9059
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009060option ldap-check
9061 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | no | yes | yes
9064 Arguments : none
9065
9066 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9067 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9068 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9069 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9070
9071 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9072 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9073
9074 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9075 configure it.
9076
9077 Example :
9078 option ldap-check
9079
9080 See also : "option httpchk"
9081
9082
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009083option external-check
9084 Use external processes for server health checks
9085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9086 yes | no | yes | yes
9087
9088 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9089 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9090 command".
9091
9092 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9093
9094 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9095
9096
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009097option log-health-checks
9098no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009099 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9101 yes | no | yes | yes
9102 Arguments : none
9103
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009104 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9105 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9106 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009107
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009108 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9109 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9110 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9111 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9112 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9113
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009114 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009115 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009116
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009117 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9118 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9119 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009120
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009121
9122option log-separate-errors
9123no option log-separate-errors
9124 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9126 yes | yes | yes | no
9127 Arguments : none
9128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009129 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009130 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9131 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9132 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9133 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9134 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9135 provides very important information.
9136
9137 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9138 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9139 error logs.
9140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009141 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009142 logging.
9143
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009144
9145option logasap
9146no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009147 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9149 yes | yes | yes | no
9150 Arguments : none
9151
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009152 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9153 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9154 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9155 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9156
9157 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9158 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9159 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9160 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9161 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009162 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009163 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9164 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9165 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9166 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009167 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009168
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009169 Examples :
9170 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9171 mode http
9172 option httplog
9173 option logasap
9174 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9175
9176 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9177 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9178 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9179 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009181 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009182 logging.
9183
9184
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009185option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009186 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9188 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009189 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009190 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9191 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009192 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9193 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009194
9195 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9196 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009197 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009198 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009199 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9200 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9201 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009202
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009203 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9204 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9205 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009206
9207 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009208 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009209 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9210 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9211 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9212 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9213 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9214 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9215 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9216
9217 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9218 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009219
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009220 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009221
9222 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9223 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9224 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9225 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009226 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009227 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009228
9229 See also: "option httpchk"
9230
9231
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009232option nolinger
9233no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009234 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9236 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009237 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009238
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009239 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009240 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9241 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9242 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9243 connections.
9244
9245 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9246 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009247 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9248 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9249 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9250 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9251 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9252 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9253 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9254 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9255 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9256 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9257 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9258 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9259 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009260
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009261 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9262 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9263 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9264 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9265 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009266
9267 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9268 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009269 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009270 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009271 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009272
9273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9275
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009276 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9277 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009278
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009279option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9280 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9282 yes | yes | yes | yes
9283 Arguments :
9284 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9285 matching <network>
9286 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9287 header name.
9288
9289 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9290 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9291 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9292 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9293 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9294 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9295 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9296 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9297 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9298 possible that the client has already brought one.
9299
9300 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9301 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9302 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9303 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9304 header and requires different one.
9305
9306 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9307 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9308 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009309 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9310 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9311 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9312 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9313 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009314
9315 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9316 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9317 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9318 both are defined.
9319
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009320 Examples :
9321 # Original Destination address
9322 frontend www
9323 mode http
9324 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9325
9326 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9327 backend www
9328 mode http
9329 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9330
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009331 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009332
9333
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009334option persist
9335no option persist
9336 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9338 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009339 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009340
9341 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9342 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9343 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9344 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9345 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9346 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9347 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9348 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9349 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9350 redirected to another valid server.
9351
9352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9354
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009355 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009356
9357
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009358option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9359 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9361 yes | no | yes | yes
9362 Arguments :
9363 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9364 PostgreSQL server.
9365
9366 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9367 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9368 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9369 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9370
9371 See also: "option httpchk"
9372
9373
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009374option prefer-last-server
9375no option prefer-last-server
9376 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9378 yes | no | yes | yes
9379 Arguments : none
9380
9381 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009382 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009383 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9384 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009385 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009386 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009387 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009388 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9389 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009390 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009391 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009392 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9393 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9394 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009395 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9396 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9397 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009398
9399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9401
9402 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9403
9404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009405option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009406option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009407no option redispatch
9408 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9410 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009411 Arguments :
9412 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9413 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9414 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009415 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009416 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009417 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009418 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9419 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9420 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009422
9423 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9424 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9425 be able to access the service anymore.
9426
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009427 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9428 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009429
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009430 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9431 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9432 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9433 following order:
9434
9435 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9436
9437 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9438 list, or
9439
9440 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9441
9442 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9443 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9444
9445 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9446 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9447 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9448 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9449
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009450 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009451 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9452 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009454 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9455 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9456
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009457 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009458
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009459
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009460option redis-check
9461 Use redis health checks for server testing
9462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9463 yes | no | yes | yes
9464 Arguments : none
9465
9466 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9467 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9468 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9469 find the "+PONG" response message.
9470
9471 Example :
9472 option redis-check
9473
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009474 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009475
9476
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009477option smtpchk
9478option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9479 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9481 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009482 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009483 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009484 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009485 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9486
9487 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9488 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9489 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9490
9491 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9492 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9493 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9494 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9495 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9496 dead server.
9497
9498 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9499 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009500 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009501 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9502
9503 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9504 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9505 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9506 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009507 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009508
9509 Example :
9510 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9511
9512 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009515option socket-stats
9516no option socket-stats
9517
9518 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9520 yes | yes | yes | no
9521
9522 Arguments : none
9523
9524
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009525option splice-auto
9526no option splice-auto
9527 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9529 yes | yes | yes | yes
9530 Arguments : none
9531
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009532 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009533 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009534 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009535 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009536 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009537 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9538 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9539 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9540 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9541
9542 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9543 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9544 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9545 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9546 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9547 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9548 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9549 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9550 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9551 keyword.
9552
9553 Example :
9554 option splice-auto
9555
9556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9558
9559 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9560 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9561
9562
9563option splice-request
9564no option splice-request
9565 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9567 yes | yes | yes | yes
9568 Arguments : none
9569
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009570 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009571 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009572 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9573 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9574 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9575 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9576
9577 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9578
9579 Example :
9580 option splice-request
9581
9582 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9583 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9584
9585 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9586 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9587
9588
9589option splice-response
9590no option splice-response
9591 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9593 yes | yes | yes | yes
9594 Arguments : none
9595
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009596 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009597 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009598 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9599 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9600 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9601 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9602
9603 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9604
9605 Example :
9606 option splice-response
9607
9608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9610
9611 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9612 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9613
9614
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009615option spop-check
9616 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9618 no | no | no | yes
9619 Arguments : none
9620
9621 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9622 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9623 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9624 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9625
9626 Example :
9627 option spop-check
9628
9629 See also : "option httpchk"
9630
9631
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009632option srvtcpka
9633no option srvtcpka
9634 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 yes | no | yes | yes
9637 Arguments : none
9638
9639 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9640 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009641 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009642 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9643
9644 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9645 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9646 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9647 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9648
9649 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9650 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9651 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9652 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9653 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9654
9655 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9656
9657 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9658 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9659 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9660
9661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9663
9664 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9665
9666
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009667option ssl-hello-chk
9668 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9670 yes | no | yes | yes
9671 Arguments : none
9672
9673 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9674 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9675 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9676 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9677 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9678 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9679 hello message.
9680
9681 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9682 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9683 messages, which is appreciable.
9684
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009685 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009686 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9687 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009688
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009689 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9690
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009691
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009692option tcp-check
9693 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9694 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9695 yes | no | yes | yes
9696
9697 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9698 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9699
9700 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9701 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9702 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9703
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009704 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009705 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9706 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9707 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9708 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9709 only.
9710
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009711 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009712 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009713 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9714 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9715 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9716
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009717 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009718 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9719 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009720 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009721 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9722 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9723 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9724 the respective protocols.
9725 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009727
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009728 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009729
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009730 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9731 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9732 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9733 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009734
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009735 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9736 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9737 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009738
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009739
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009740 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009741 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009742 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009743 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009744
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009745 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009746 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009747 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009748
9749 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9750 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009751 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009752 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009753 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009754 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009755 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009756 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009757 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9758 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009759 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009760 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9761 tcp-check expect string +OK
9762
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009763 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009764 (send many headers before analyzing)
9765 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009766 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009767 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9768 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9769 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9770 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009771 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009772
9773
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009774 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009775
9776
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009777option tcp-smart-accept
9778no option tcp-smart-accept
9779 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9781 yes | yes | yes | no
9782 Arguments : none
9783
9784 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9785 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9786 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9787 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9788 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9789 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9790
9791 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9792 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9793 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9794 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9795
9796 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9797 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9798 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009799 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009800
9801 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9802 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9803 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9804
9805 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9806 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9807 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9808
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009809 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9810
9811
9812option tcp-smart-connect
9813no option tcp-smart-connect
9814 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9816 yes | no | yes | yes
9817 Arguments : none
9818
9819 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9820 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9821 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9822 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9823 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9824
9825 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9826 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9827 complex.
9828
9829 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9830 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9831 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9832
9833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9835
9836 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9837
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009838
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009839option tcpka
9840 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9842 yes | yes | yes | yes
9843 Arguments : none
9844
9845 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9846 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009847 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009848 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9849
9850 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9851 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9852 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9853 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9854
9855 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9856 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9857 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9858 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9859 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9860
9861 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9862
9863 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9864 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9865 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9866 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9867 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9868 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9869 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9870 backends.
9871
9872 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9873
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009874
9875option tcplog
9876 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009878 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009879 Arguments : none
9880
9881 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9882 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9883 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9884 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9885 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9886 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9887 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9888 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9889
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009890 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009892 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009893
9894
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009895option transparent
9896no option transparent
9897 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009899 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009900 Arguments : none
9901
9902 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9903 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9904 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9905 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9906 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9907 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9908 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9909 appropriate server.
9910
9911 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9912 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9913
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009914 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009915 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009916
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009917
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009918external-check command <command>
9919 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9921 yes | no | yes | yes
9922
9923 Arguments :
9924 <command> is the external command to run
9925
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009926 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9927
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009928 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009929
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009930 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9931 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9932 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9933 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9934 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9935 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009936
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009937 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9938
9939 Environment variables :
9940 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9941 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9942
9943 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9944
9945 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9946
9947 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9948 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9949 for a UNIX socket).
9950
9951 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9952
9953 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9954
9955 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9956
9957 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9958
9959 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9960
9961 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9962 socket).
9963
9964 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9965 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9966
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009967 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9968
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009969 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9970 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9971 failed.
9972
9973 Example :
9974 external-check command /bin/true
9975
9976 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9977
9978
9979external-check path <path>
9980 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9982 yes | no | yes | yes
9983
9984 Arguments :
9985 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9986
9987 The default path is "".
9988
9989 Example :
9990 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9991
9992 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9993 "external-check command"
9994
9995
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009996persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009997persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009998 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10000 yes | no | yes | yes
10001 Arguments :
10002 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010003 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10004 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010005
10006 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10007 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010008 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010009 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10010 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10011 forwarded to this server.
10012
10013 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10014 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10015 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010016 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010017 a single "listen" section.
10018
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010019 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10020 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10021 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10022
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010023 Example :
10024 listen tse-farm
10025 bind :3389
10026 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10027 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10028 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10029 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10030 persist rdp-cookie
10031 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010032 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010033 balance rdp-cookie
10034 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10035 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10036
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +090010037 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
10038 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010039
10040
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010041rate-limit sessions <rate>
10042 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10044 yes | yes | yes | no
10045 Arguments :
10046 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10047 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10048
10049 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10050 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10051 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010052 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010053 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10054 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10055
10056 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10057 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10058 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10059 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10060
10061 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10062 listen smtp
10063 mode tcp
10064 bind :25
10065 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010066 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010067
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010068 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10069 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10070 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010071
10072 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10073
10074
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010075redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10076redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10077redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010078 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10080 no | yes | yes | yes
10081
10082 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010083 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010084
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010085 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010086 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010087 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10088 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10089 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010090
10091 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10092 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10093 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10094 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10095 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010096 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10097 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10098 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10099 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010100
10101 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10102 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10103 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10104 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10105 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10106 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010107 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010108 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010109 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10110 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10111 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010112
10113 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010114 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10115 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10116 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010117 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010118 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10119 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10120 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10121 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010122
10123 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010124 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010125
10126 - "drop-query"
10127 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10128 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10129 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10130 with a location-type redirect.
10131
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010132 - "append-slash"
10133 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10134 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10135 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10136 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10137
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010138 - "ignore-empty"
10139 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10140 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10141 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10142 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10143 of known paths using a simple map.
10144
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010145 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10146 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10147 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10148 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10149 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10150 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10151 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10152
10153 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10154 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10155 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10156 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10157 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10158 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10159 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010160
10161 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10162 acl clear dst_port 80
10163 acl secure dst_port 8080
10164 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010165 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010166 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010167 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10168
10169 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010170 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10171 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10172 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010173 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010174
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010175 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10176 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10177 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010179 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010180 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010181
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010182 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010183 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10184 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10185 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010186
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010187 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10188 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10189 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010191 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010192
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010193
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010194retries <value>
10195 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10196 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10197 yes | no | yes | yes
10198 Arguments :
10199 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10200 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10201 default value is 3.
10202
10203 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10204 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10205 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10206
10207 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010208 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10209 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010210
10211 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10212 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10213
10214 See also : "option redispatch"
10215
10216
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010217retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010218 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10219 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10220 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 yes | no | yes | yes
10223 Arguments :
10224 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10225 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10226 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10227 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10228
10229 none never retry
10230
10231 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10232 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10233
10234 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10235 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10236 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10237 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10238 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10239 processing the request.
10240
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010241 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10242 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10243 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10244 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10245 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10246 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10247 overflow attack for example).
10248
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010249 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10250 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10251 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10252 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10253 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10254 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10255 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10256 amplify denial of service attacks.
10257
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010258 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10259 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10260 considered to be safe to retry.
10261
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010262 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10263 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10264 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10265 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10266 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010267
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010268 all-retryable-errors
10269 retry request for any error that are considered
10270 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10271 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10272 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10273
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010274 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10275 not cumulative.
10276
10277 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10278 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10279 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10280 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10281
10282 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10283 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10284 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10285 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10286 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10287 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10288 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10289 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10290 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10291 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10292 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10293 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10294
10295 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10296 should not use this directive.
10297
10298 The default is "conn-failure".
10299
10300 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10301
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010302server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303 Declare a server in a backend
10304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10305 no | no | yes | yes
10306 Arguments :
10307 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010308 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010309 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010310
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010311 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10312 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10313 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10314 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010315 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10316 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010317 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010318 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10319 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010320 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10321 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10322 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10323 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10324 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10325 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10326 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010327 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010328 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10329 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10330 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10331 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10332 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10333 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010334 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10335 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010336 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10337 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010338
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010339 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010340 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10341 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10342 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10343 adding this value to the client's port.
10344
10345 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10346 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010347 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010348
10349 Examples :
10350 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10351 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010352 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010353 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10354 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10355 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010357 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10358 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10359 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10360 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10361 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10362
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010363 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10364 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010365
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010366server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010367 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010368 this backend.
10369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10370 no | no | yes | yes
10371
10372 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10373 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10374 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10375 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10376 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010377
10378 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10379 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10380
10381 global
10382 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10383
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010384 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010385 load-server-state-from-file
10386
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010387 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010388 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010389
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010390server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10391 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10392 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10394 no | no | yes | yes
10395
10396 Arguments:
10397 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10398
10399 <num | range>
10400 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10401 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10402 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10403 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10404
10405 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10406
10407 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10408
10409 <params*>
10410 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10411 keyword.
10412
10413 Examples:
10414 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10415 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10416 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10417
10418 # or
10419 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10420
10421 # would be equivalent to:
10422 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10423 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10424 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10425
10426
10427
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010428source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010429source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010430source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10433 yes | no | yes | yes
10434 Arguments :
10435 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10436 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010437
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010438 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010439 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10440 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10441 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10442 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10443 supported prefixes are :
10444 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10445 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10446 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010447 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010448 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10449 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010450
10451 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10452 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010453 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10454 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10455 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010456
10457 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10458 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10459 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10460 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10461 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10462 <addr>.
10463
10464 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10465 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10466 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10467 port.
10468
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010469 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10470 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10471 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10472 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010473 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010474 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10475 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10476 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10477 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10478 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10479 HTTP header.
10480
10481 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10482 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010483 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010484 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10485 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10486 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10487 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10488 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10489 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10490 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10491
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010492 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10493 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10494 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10495 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10496 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10497 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10498
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010499 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10500 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10501 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10502 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10503
10504 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10505 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10506 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10507 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10508 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10509 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10510
10511 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10512 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10513 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10514 there are two methods :
10515
10516 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10517 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10518 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10519 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10520 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10521 of the client ranges may be used.
10522
10523 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10524 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10525 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10526 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10527 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10528 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10529 same session.
10530
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010531 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10532 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10533 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010534 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010535
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010536 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10537
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010538 Examples :
10539 backend private
10540 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10541 source 192.168.1.200
10542
10543 backend transparent_ssl1
10544 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10545 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10546
10547 backend transparent_ssl2
10548 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10549 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10550 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10551
10552 backend transparent_ssl3
10553 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10554 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10555 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10556
10557 backend transparent_smtp
10558 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10559 # with Tproxy version 4.
10560 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10561
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010562 backend transparent_http
10563 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10564 # proxy.
10565 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010567 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010568 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10569
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010570
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010571srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10572 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10573 the connection on the server side.
10574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10575 yes | no | yes | yes
10576 Arguments :
10577 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10578
10579 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10580 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010581 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10582 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010583
10584 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10585
10586
10587srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10588 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10589 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10590 server side.
10591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10592 yes | no | yes | yes
10593 Arguments :
10594 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10595 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10596 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10597 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10598
10599 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10600 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010601 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10602 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010603
10604 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10605
10606
10607srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10608 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10610 yes | no | yes | yes
10611 Arguments :
10612 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10613 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10614 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10615 document.
10616
10617 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10618 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010619 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10620 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010621
10622 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10623
10624
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010625stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10626 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010628 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010629
10630 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10631 matched.
10632
10633 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10634 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10635
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010636 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10637 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10638 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10639 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010640
10641 Example :
10642 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10643 backend stats_localhost
10644 stats enable
10645 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10646
10647 Example :
10648 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10649 backend stats_auth
10650 stats enable
10651 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10652 stats admin if TRUE
10653
10654 Example :
10655 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10656 userlist stats-auth
10657 group admin users admin
10658 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10659 group readonly users haproxy
10660 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10661
10662 backend stats_auth
10663 stats enable
10664 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10665 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10666 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10667 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10668
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010669 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10670 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010671
10672
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010673stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10674 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010676 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010677 Arguments :
10678 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10679
10680 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10681
10682 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10683 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10684 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10685 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10686 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10687 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10688
10689 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10690 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10691 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010692 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010693
10694 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10695 report using "stats scope".
10696
10697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10699 unobvious parameters.
10700
10701 Example :
10702 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10703 backend public_www
10704 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10705 stats enable
10706 stats hide-version
10707 stats scope .
10708 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10711 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10712
10713 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10714 backend private_monitoring
10715 stats enable
10716 stats uri /admin?stats
10717 stats refresh 5s
10718
10719 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10720
10721
10722stats enable
10723 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726 Arguments : none
10727
10728 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10729 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10730 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10731 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10732 - stats auth : no authentication
10733 - stats scope : no restriction
10734
10735 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10736 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10737 unobvious parameters.
10738
10739 Example :
10740 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10741 backend public_www
10742 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10743 stats enable
10744 stats hide-version
10745 stats scope .
10746 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010747 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010748 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10749 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10750
10751 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10752 backend private_monitoring
10753 stats enable
10754 stats uri /admin?stats
10755 stats refresh 5s
10756
10757 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10758
10759
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010760stats hide-version
10761 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010763 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010764 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010765
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010766 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10767 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10768 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10769 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10770 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10771 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10775 unobvious parameters.
10776
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777 Example :
10778 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10779 backend public_www
10780 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010781 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010782 stats hide-version
10783 stats scope .
10784 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010786 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10787 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010788
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010789 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10790 backend private_monitoring
10791 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010792 stats uri /admin?stats
10793 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010794
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010796
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010797
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010798stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10799 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10800 Access control for statistics
10801
10802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10803 no | no | yes | yes
10804
10805 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10806 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10807 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10808 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10809 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10810 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10811
10812 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10813 instance.
10814
10815 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10816 about ACL usage.
10817
10818
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010819stats realm <realm>
10820 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010822 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010823 Arguments :
10824 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10825 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10826 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10827
10828 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10829 using a backslash ('\').
10830
10831 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10832 only related to authentication.
10833
10834 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10835 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10836 unobvious parameters.
10837
10838 Example :
10839 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10840 backend public_www
10841 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10842 stats enable
10843 stats hide-version
10844 stats scope .
10845 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010847 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10848 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10849
10850 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10851 backend private_monitoring
10852 stats enable
10853 stats uri /admin?stats
10854 stats refresh 5s
10855
10856 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10857
10858
10859stats refresh <delay>
10860 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010862 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010863 Arguments :
10864 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10865 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10866 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10867 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10868 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10869 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10870
10871 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10872 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10873 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010874 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010875
10876 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10877 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10878 unobvious parameters.
10879
10880 Example :
10881 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10882 backend public_www
10883 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10884 stats enable
10885 stats hide-version
10886 stats scope .
10887 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010888 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10890 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10891
10892 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10893 backend private_monitoring
10894 stats enable
10895 stats uri /admin?stats
10896 stats refresh 5s
10897
10898 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10899
10900
10901stats scope { <name> | "." }
10902 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010904 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010905 Arguments :
10906 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10907 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10908 section in which the statement appears.
10909
10910 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10911 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10912 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10913 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10914 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10915 exists.
10916
10917 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10918 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10919 unobvious parameters.
10920
10921 Example :
10922 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10923 backend public_www
10924 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10925 stats enable
10926 stats hide-version
10927 stats scope .
10928 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010929 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010930 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10931 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10932
10933 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10934 backend private_monitoring
10935 stats enable
10936 stats uri /admin?stats
10937 stats refresh 5s
10938
10939 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10940
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010942stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010943 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010945 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010946
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010947 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010948 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10949
10950 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10951 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10952
10953 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10954 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010955 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010956
10957 Example :
10958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10959 backend private_monitoring
10960 stats enable
10961 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10962 stats uri /admin?stats
10963 stats refresh 5s
10964
10965 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10966 global section.
10967
10968
10969stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010970 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10972 yes | yes | yes | yes
10973 Arguments : none
10974
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010975 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010976 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10977 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10978 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10979 - IP (socket, server)
10980 - cookie (backend, server)
10981
10982 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10983 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010984 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010985
10986 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10987
10988
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010989stats show-modules
10990 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10992 yes | yes | yes | yes
10993 Arguments : none
10994
10995 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10996 values as a tooltip.
10997
10998 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10999 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11000 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11001
11002 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11003
11004
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011005stats show-node [ <name> ]
11006 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011008 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011009 Arguments:
11010 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11011 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11012
11013 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11014 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011016
11017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11019 unobvious parameters.
11020
11021 Example:
11022 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11023 backend private_monitoring
11024 stats enable
11025 stats show-node Europe-1
11026 stats uri /admin?stats
11027 stats refresh 5s
11028
11029 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11030 section.
11031
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011032
11033stats uri <prefix>
11034 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011036 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011037 Arguments :
11038 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11039 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11040 query string.
11041
11042 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11043 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11044 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11045 possible to reach it in the application.
11046
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011047 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011048 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011049 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11050 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11051 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11052 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11053
11054 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11055 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11056 an address or a port to statistics only.
11057
11058 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11059 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11060 unobvious parameters.
11061
11062 Example :
11063 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11064 backend public_www
11065 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11066 stats enable
11067 stats hide-version
11068 stats scope .
11069 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011071 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11072 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11073
11074 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11075 backend private_monitoring
11076 stats enable
11077 stats uri /admin?stats
11078 stats refresh 5s
11079
11080 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11081
11082
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011083stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11084 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011086 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011087
11088 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011089 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011090 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011091 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011092 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11093
11094 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11095 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11096 the "stick-table" statement.
11097
11098 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11099 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11100 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11101 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11102 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11103
11104 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11105 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11106 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11107 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11108 transformation rules.
11109
11110 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11111 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11112 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11113 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11114 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11115 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11116 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11117
11118 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11119 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11120 ACL based conditions.
11121
11122 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11123 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11124 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11125 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11126
11127 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11128 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11129 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11130 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11131
11132 Example :
11133 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11134 # last 30 minutes
11135 backend pop
11136 mode tcp
11137 balance roundrobin
11138 stick store-request src
11139 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11140 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11141 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11142
11143 backend smtp
11144 mode tcp
11145 balance roundrobin
11146 stick match src table pop
11147 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11148 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11149
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011150 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11151 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011152
11153
11154stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11155 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11157 no | no | yes | yes
11158
11159 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11160 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11161 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11162 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11163
11164 Examples :
11165 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011166 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011167
11168 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11169 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11170 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11171
11172
11173 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11174 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11175 backend http
11176 mode http
11177 balance roundrobin
11178 stick on src table https
11179 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11180 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11181 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11182
11183 backend https
11184 mode tcp
11185 balance roundrobin
11186 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11187 stick on src
11188 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11189 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11190
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011191 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192
11193
11194stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11195 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11197 no | no | yes | yes
11198
11199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011200 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011201 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011202 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011203 server is selected.
11204
11205 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11206 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11207 the "stick-table" statement.
11208
11209 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11210 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11211 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11212 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11213 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11214 address.
11215
11216 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11217 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11218 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11219 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11220 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11221 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11222 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11223 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11224 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11225 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11226
11227 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11228 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11229 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11230 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11231 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11232 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11233 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11234
11235 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11236 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11237 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11238 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11239
11240 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11241 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11242 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11243 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11244 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11245 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011246 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11247 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11248 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11249 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11250 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11251 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011252
11253 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11254 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11255 the request.
11256
11257 Example :
11258 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11259 # last 30 minutes
11260 backend pop
11261 mode tcp
11262 balance roundrobin
11263 stick store-request src
11264 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11265 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11266 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11267
11268 backend smtp
11269 mode tcp
11270 balance roundrobin
11271 stick match src table pop
11272 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11273 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11274
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011275 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011276
11277
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011278stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011279 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011280 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011281 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011283 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011284
11285 Arguments :
11286 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11287 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11288 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11289 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11290
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011291 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11292 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11293 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11294 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11295
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011296 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11297 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11298 instance.
11299
11300 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11301 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11302 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11303 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11304 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11305 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011306 to 32 characters.
11307
11308 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11309 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11310 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011311 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011312 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11313 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011314
11315 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011316 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11317 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011318 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11319 increase.
11320
11321 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011322 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11323 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11324 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011325
11326 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011327 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011328 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11329 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011330 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011331 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11332 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11333 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11334 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11335 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11336 parameter (see below).
11337
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011338 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11339 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11340 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11341 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11342 soft restart.
11343
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011344 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11345 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11346 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11347 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011348 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011349 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011350 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11351 if not expiration delay is specified.
11352
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011353 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11354 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11355 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11356 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11357 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11358 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11359 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11360 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11361 token.
11362
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011363 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11364 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11365 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11366 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011367 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11368 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11369 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11370 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11371 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11372 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11373 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11374 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11375 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11376 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11377 types and their arguments.
11378
11379 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11380 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11381 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11382 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11383
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011384 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11385 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11386 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11387 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11388 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11389 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11390 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11391 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11392 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11393 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011394 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11395 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11396 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11397 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011398
11399 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11400 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11401 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11402 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11403 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11404 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11405 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11406 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11407 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11408 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11409 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11410 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011411 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11412 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11413 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11414 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011415
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011416 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11417 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11418 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011419 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011420
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011421 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11422 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11423 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011424 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011425 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011426 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011427
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011428 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11429 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11430 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11431 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11432
11433 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11434 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11435 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11436 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11437 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11438 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11439
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011440 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11441 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11442 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11443 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11444 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11445 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11446 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11447 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11448 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11449 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011450 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11451 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11452 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011453
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011454 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11455 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11456 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11457 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11458
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011459 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11460 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11461 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11462 they were received.
11463
11464 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11465 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11466 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11467 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11468 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11469
11470 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11471 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11472 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11473 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11474 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11475
11476 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11477 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11478 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11479
11480 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11481 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11482 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11483 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11484 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11485
11486 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11487 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11488 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11489 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11490 the client side.
11491
11492 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11493 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11494 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11495 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11496 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11497 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11498 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11499
11500 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11501 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11502 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11503 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11504 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11505 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011507
11508 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11509 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11510 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11511 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11512 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11513 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11514
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011515 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11516 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11517 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11518 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11519 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11520
11521 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11522 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11523 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11524 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11525 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11526 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11527
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011528 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011529 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011530 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11531 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11532
11533 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11534 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11535 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11536 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11537 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11538 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11539 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11540 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11541 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11542 recommended for better fairness.
11543
11544 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011546 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11547 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11548
11549 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11550 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11551 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11552 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11553 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11554 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11555 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11556 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11557 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11558 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011559
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011560 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11561 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011562 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11563 reference it.
11564
11565 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11566 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011567 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11568 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11569 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011570
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011571 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11572 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11573 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11574 something that can be ignored.
11575
11576 Example:
11577 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11578 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11579 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11580 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11581
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011582 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011583 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011584
11585
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011586stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011587 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11589 no | no | yes | yes
11590
11591 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011592 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011593 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011594 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011595 server is selected.
11596
11597 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11598 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11599 the "stick-table" statement.
11600
11601 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11602 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11603 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11604 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11605
11606 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11607 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11608 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11609 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11610 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11611 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011612 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011613 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11614 rules.
11615
11616 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11617 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11618 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11619 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11620 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11621 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11622 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11623
11624 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11625 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11626 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11627 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11628
11629 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11630 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11631 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11632 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11633 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11634 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011635 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11636 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11637 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11638 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11639 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11640 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11641 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11642 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11643 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011644
11645 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11646
11647 Example :
11648 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11649 backend https
11650 mode tcp
11651 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011652 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011653 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011654
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011655 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11656 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11657
11658 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11659 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11660 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11661
11662 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11663 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011664
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011665 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11666 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11667 # at offset 44.
11668
11669 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11670 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11671
11672 # Learn on response if server hello.
11673 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011674
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011675 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11676 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11677
11678 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11679 extraction.
11680
11681
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011682tcp-check comment <string>
11683 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11684 it fails.
11685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11686 yes | no | yes | yes
11687
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011688 Arguments :
11689 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11690 rule fails.
11691
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011692 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11693 user-friendly error reporting.
11694
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011695 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11696 "tcp-check expect".
11697
11698
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011699tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11700 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011701 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011702 Opens a new connection
11703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011704 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011705
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011706 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011707 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11708
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011709 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011710 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011711
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011712 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011713 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11714 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011715 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011716
11717 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011718
11719 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11720
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011721 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11722
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011723 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11724
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011725 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11726
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011727 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11728 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11729 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11730 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11731
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011732 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11733 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11734 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11735 haproxy -vv.
11736
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011737 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011738
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011739 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11740 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11741 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11742
11743 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11744 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11745 of the sequence.
11746
11747 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11748 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11749 do.
11750
11751 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11752 unset-var or comment rules.
11753
11754 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011755 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11756 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11757 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11758 option tcp-check
11759 tcp-check connect
11760 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11761 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11762 tcp-check send \r\n
11763 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11764 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11765 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11766 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11767 tcp-check send \r\n
11768 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11769 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11770
11771 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11772 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011773 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011774 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11775 tcp-check connect port 143
11776 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11777 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11778
11779 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11780
11781
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011782tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011783 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011784 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011785 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011788 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011789
11790 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011791 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11792
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011793 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11794 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11795 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11796 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11797 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11798 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11799 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11800 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11801 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11802 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11803
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011804 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011805 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11806 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011807 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11808 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11809 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11810
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011811 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11812 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11813 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011814 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11815 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011816 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11817 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011818 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11819 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011820 By default "L7OK" is used.
11821
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011822 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11823 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011824 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11825 supported :
11826 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11827 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011828 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11829 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11830 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11831 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11832 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011833
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011834 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011835 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011836 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11837 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11838 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11839 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011840 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11841
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011842 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11843 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11844 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11845 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11846
11847 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11848 informational message reported in logs if an error
11849 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11850 log-format string.
11851
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011852 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11853 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11854 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11855 followed by some converters.
11856
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011857 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11858 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11859 with the usual backslash ('\').
11860 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011861 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011862 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11863 used upper or lower case.
11864
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011865 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11866
11867 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11868 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11869 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11870 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11871 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11872 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11873 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11874 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11875
11876 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11877 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11878 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11879 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11880 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11881 expression.
11882
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011883 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11884 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11885 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11886 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11887 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11888 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11889
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011890 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11891 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11892 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11893 this exact hexadecimal string.
11894 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11895
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011896 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11897 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11898 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11899 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11900 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11901 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11902 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11903 size.
11904
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011905 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11906 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11907 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11908 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11909 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11910 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11911 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11912 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11913 in a binary string before matching the response's
11914 buffer.
11915
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011916 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011917 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011918 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11919 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11920 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11921 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11922 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11923 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11924 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11925 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11926 the null character.
11927
11928 Examples :
11929 # perform a POP check
11930 option tcp-check
11931 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11932
11933 # perform an IMAP check
11934 option tcp-check
11935 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11936
11937 # look for the redis master server
11938 option tcp-check
11939 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011940 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011941 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11942 tcp-check expect string role:master
11943 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11944 tcp-check expect string +OK
11945
11946
11947 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011948 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949
11950
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011951tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11952tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11953 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11954 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011956 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011957
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011958 Arguments :
11959 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11960
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011961 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11962 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011963
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011964 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11965 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011966
11967 Examples :
11968 # look for the redis master server
11969 option tcp-check
11970 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11971 tcp-check expect string role:master
11972
11973 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011974 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011975
11976
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011977tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11978tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11979 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11980 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011982 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011983
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011984 Arguments :
11985 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011986
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011987 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11988 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011989
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011990 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11991 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11992 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011993
11994 Examples :
11995 # redis check in binary
11996 option tcp-check
11997 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11998 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11999
12000
12001 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012002 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012003
12004
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012005tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012006tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012007 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012009 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012010
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012011 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012012 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12013 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12014 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12015 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12016 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12017 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12018 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12019 and '-'.
12020
12021 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12022
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012023 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12024 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12025
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012026 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012027 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012028 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012029
12030
12031tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012032 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012034 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012035
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012036 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012037 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12038 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12039 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12040 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12041 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12042 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12043 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12044 and '-'.
12045
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012046 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012047 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12048
12049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012050tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12051 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12053 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012055 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12056 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012058 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012059
12060 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12061 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012062 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12063 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12064 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12065 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12066 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12067 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012069 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12070 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12071 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12072 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012073
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012074 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012075 - accept :
12076 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12077 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12078 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012080 - reject :
12081 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12082 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12083 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12084 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12085 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12086 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12087 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12088 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12089 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12090 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12091 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012092 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012093
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012094 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12095 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12096 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12097 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12098 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12099 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12100 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12101 hosts.
12102
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012103 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12104 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12105 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12106 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12107 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12108 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12109 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12110 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12111
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012112 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12113 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12114 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12115 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12116 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12117 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12118 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12119 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12120 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012121 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12122 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012123
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012124 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012125 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012126 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12127 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12128 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012129 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012130 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012131 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12132 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12133 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12134 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12135 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12136 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12137 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012139 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012140 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012141 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012142 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012143 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12144 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12145 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012147 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12148 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12149 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12150 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012151
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012152 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12153 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12154 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12155 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12156 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012157 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12158 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12159 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12160 layer7 information is extracted.
12161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012162 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12163 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12164 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12165 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12166 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012167
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012168 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12169 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12170 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12171 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12172 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12173 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12174 no GPC stored at this index.
12175 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12176 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12177 data_types).
12178
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012179 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12180 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12181 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12182 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12183
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012184 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12185 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12186 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12187 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12188
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012189 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12190 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12191 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12192 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12193 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12194 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12195 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12196 no GPT stored at this index.
12197 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12198 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12199
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012200 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12201 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12202 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12203 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12204 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012205
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012206 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012207 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12208 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12209 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12210 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12211 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12212 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12213 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12214 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012215 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012216
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012217 - set-src <expr> :
12218 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12219 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12220 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012221 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012223 Arguments:
12224 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12225 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012226
12227 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012228 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12229
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012230 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12231 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012232
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012233 - set-src-port <expr> :
12234 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12235 expression.
12236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012237 Arguments:
12238 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12239 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012240
12241 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012242 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12243
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012244 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12245 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12246 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012247
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012248 - set-dst <expr> :
12249 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12250 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12251 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12252 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12253 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12254
12255 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12256 followed by some converters.
12257
12258 Example:
12259
12260 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12261 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12262
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012263 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12264 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12265
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012266 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12267 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12268 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12269 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12270
12271
12272 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12273 followed by some converters.
12274
12275 Example:
12276
12277 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12278
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012279 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12280 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12281 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12282
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012283 - set-tos <tos>:
12284 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12285 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12286 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12287 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12288 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12289 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12290 routers based on some information from the request.
12291
12292 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12293
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012294 - "silent-drop" :
12295 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012296 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012297 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12298 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12299 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12300 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12301 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012302 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12303 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012304 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12305 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012306 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012307 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12308 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12309 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12310 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012312 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12313 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12314 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012316 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12317 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12318 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012319
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012320 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012321 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012322 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012324 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12325 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12326 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012327
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012328 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012329 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12330 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012331
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012332 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12333
12334 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12335
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012336 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12337
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012338 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012339
12340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012341tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12342 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012344 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012346 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12347 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012349 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012351 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012352 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12353 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012354 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12355 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012357 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12358 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12359 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12360 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012361 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012362 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012363 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12364 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12365 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12366 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012367 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012368 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012370 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12371 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12372 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12373 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012374
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012375 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012376 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012377 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012378 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12379 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012380 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012381 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012382 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012383 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012384 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012385 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012386 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012387 - set-dst <expr>
12388 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012389 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012390 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012391 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012392 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012393 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012394 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012395 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012396 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012397 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012398 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012399 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012400
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012401 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12402 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012403 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12404 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012405
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012406 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12407 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12408 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12409 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12410 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12411 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012413 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012414 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12415 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012416
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012417 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12418 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12419 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12420 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12421 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12422 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12423
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012424 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012425 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12426 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12427 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12428 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12429 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12430 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12431 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12432 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12433 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12434 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012435
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012436 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012437 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12438 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12439 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012440
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012441 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12442 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12443
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012444 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12445 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12446
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012447 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12448 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12449
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012450 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12451 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12452
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012453 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12454 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12455
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012456 The "set-var" and "set-var-fmt" are used to set the contents of a variable.
12457 The variable is declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only
12458 session-level variables can be used, without any layer7 contents. The
12459 "set-var" action takes a regular expression while "set-var-fmt" takes a
12460 format string.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012461
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012462 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12463 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012464 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012465 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12466 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012467 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012468 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012469 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012470 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12471 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012472 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012473 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12474 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012475
12476 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12477 followed by some converters.
12478
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012479 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12480 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12481
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012482 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012483 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12484 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12485 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12486 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12487 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12488 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012489 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012490 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12491 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12492
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012493 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12494
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012495 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12496 <var-name>.
12497
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012498 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12499 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12500 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12501 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12502 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12503
12504 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12505 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12506 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12507 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12508 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12509 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12510 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12511 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12512 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12513 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12514 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12515
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012516 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12517 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12518 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12519 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12520 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12521
12522 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12523
12524 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12525
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012526 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12527 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12528 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12529 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12530 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12531 evaluated.
12532
12533 Example:
12534 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12535
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012536 Example:
12537
12538 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012539 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012540 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012541
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012542 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012543 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012544 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012545 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12546 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012547 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012548 tcp-request content reject
12549
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012550 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12551 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12552 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12553 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12554 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12555 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12556 ...
12557 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012559 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012560 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12561 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12562 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012563 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012564
12565 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12566 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12567 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012568 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012569 tcp-request content reject
12570
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012571 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012572 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012573 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012574 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012575 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12576 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012577
12578 Example:
12579 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12580 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012581 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012583 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012584 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012585
12586 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012587 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012588 # protecting all our sites
12589 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012590 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12591 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012592 ...
12593 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12594
12595 backend http_dynamic
12596 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012597 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012598 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012599 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012600 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012601 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012602 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012604 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012605
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012606 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12607 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012608
12609
12610tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12611 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012613 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012614 Arguments :
12615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12617 as explained at the top of this document.
12618
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012619 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012620 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12621 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12622 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12623 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12624
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012625 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12626 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12627 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12628 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12629
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012630 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012631 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012632 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012633 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012634 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012635 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12636 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12637 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012638
12639 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12640 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12641 it pass through unaffected.
12642
12643 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12644 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12645 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012646 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12648 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012649 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12650 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12651 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012652
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012653 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012654 "timeout client".
12655
12656
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012657tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12658 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12660 no | yes | yes | no
12661 Arguments :
12662 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12663 below.
12664
12665 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12666
12667 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12668 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12669 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12670 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12671 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12672 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12673 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12674 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12675 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12676 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12677 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12678 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12679 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12680 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12681 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12682 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12683 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12684 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12685 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12686 instead.
12687
12688 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12689 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12690 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12691 rules which may be inserted.
12692
12693 Several types of actions are supported :
12694 - accept : the request is accepted
12695 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12696 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12697 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12698 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12699 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12700 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12701 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12702 - set-mark <mark>
12703 - set-dst <expr>
12704 - set-dst-port <expr>
12705 - set-src <expr>
12706 - set-src-port <expr>
12707 - set-tos <tos>
12708 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12709 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
12710 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12711 - silent-drop
12712
12713 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12714 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12715 sections for a complete description.
12716
12717 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12718 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12719 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12720
12721 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12722 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12723 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12724 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12725 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12726
12727 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12728 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12729
12730 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12731 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12732 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12733
12734 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12735 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12736 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12737
12738 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12739 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12740 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12741
12742 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12743 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12744 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12745
12746 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12747
12748 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12749
12750
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012751tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12752 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12754 no | no | yes | yes
12755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012756 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12757 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012758
12759 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12760
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012761 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012762 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12763 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012764 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12765 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012766
12767 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12768
12769 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12770 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12771 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12772 inserted.
12773
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012774 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012775 - accept :
12776 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12777 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12778 the rules evaluation.
12779
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012780 - close :
12781 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12782 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12783 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12784 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12785 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12786 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012787 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012788 protocols.
12789
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012790 - reject :
12791 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12792 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012793 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012794
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012795 - set-log-level <level>
12796 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12797 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12798 set-log-level".
12799
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012800 - set-mark <mark>
12801 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12802 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12803 set-mark".
12804
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012805 - set-nice <nice>
12806 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12807 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12808 set-nice".
12809
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012810 - set-tos <tos>
12811 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12812 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12813 set-tos".
12814
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012815 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreaue7267122021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012816 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012817
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012818 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
12819 Sets a variable from a log format string.
12820
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012821 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12822 Unsets a variable.
12823
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012824 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12825 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12826 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12827 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12828 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12829 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12830 no GPC stored at this index.
12831 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12832 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12833 data_types).
12834
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012835 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12836 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12837 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12838 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12839
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012840 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12841 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12842 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12843 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12844
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012845 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12846 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12847 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12848 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12849 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12850 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12851 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12852 no GPT stored at this index.
12853 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12854 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12855
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012856 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12857 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12858 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12859 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12860 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012861
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012862 - "silent-drop" :
12863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012864 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012865 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12866 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12867 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12868 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12869 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012870 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12871 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012872 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12873 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012874 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012875 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12876 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12877 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12878 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12879
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012880 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12881 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12882
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012883 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12884 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12885 for changing the default action to a reject.
12886
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012887 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12888 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12889 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12890 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012891 period.
12892
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012893 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12894 declared inline.
12895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012896 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12897 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012898 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012899 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12900 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012901 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012902 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012903 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12905 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012906 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012907 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12908 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012909
12910 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12911 followed by some converters.
12912
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012913 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12914 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12915
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012916 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12917 <var-name>.
12918
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012919 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12920 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12921 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12922 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12923 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12924
12925 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12926
12927 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12928
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012929 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12930
12931 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12932
12933
12934tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12935 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12937 no | no | yes | yes
12938 Arguments :
12939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12941 as explained at the top of this document.
12942
12943 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12944
12945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012946timeout check <timeout>
12947 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12948 established.
12949
12950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12951 yes | no | yes | yes
12952 Arguments:
12953 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12955 as explained at the top of this document.
12956
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012957 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012958 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012959 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012960 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012961 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12962 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12963 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012964
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012965 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012966 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12967
12968 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12969 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012970 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012971
12972 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12973 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12974 forget about it.
12975
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012976 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12977 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012978
12979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012980timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012981 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12983 yes | yes | yes | no
12984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012985 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012986 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12987 as explained at the top of this document.
12988
12989 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12990 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12991 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012992 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12993 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12994 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12995 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012996 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12997 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12998 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012999 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013000 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013001 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13002 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013003 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13004 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013005
13006 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13007 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13008 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13009 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013010 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013011 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13012
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013013 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013014
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013015 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013017
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013018timeout client-fin <timeout>
13019 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13021 yes | yes | yes | no
13022 Arguments :
13023 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13025 as explained at the top of this document.
13026
13027 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13028 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13029 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13030 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13031 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13032 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13033 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013034 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13035 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13036 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013037
13038 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13039 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13040 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13041
13042 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13043
13044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013045timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013046 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13048 yes | no | yes | yes
13049 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013050 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013051 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13052 as explained at the top of this document.
13053
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013054 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013055 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013056 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013057 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013058 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13059 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013060
13061 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13062 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13063 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13064 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013065 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013066 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13067
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013068 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013070
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013071timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13072 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13074 yes | yes | yes | yes
13075 Arguments :
13076 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13077 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13078 as explained at the top of this document.
13079
13080 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13081 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13082 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13083 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13084 once the request has started to present itself.
13085
13086 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13087 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13088 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13089 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13090 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13091
13092 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13093 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13094 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13095 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13096
13097 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13098 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013099 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013100 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13101 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013102 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013103
13104 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13105 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13106 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13107 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13108
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013109 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
13110 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013111 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
13112
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013113 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13114
13115
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013116timeout http-request <timeout>
13117 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013119 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013120 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13123 as explained at the top of this document.
13124
13125 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13126 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13127 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13128 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13129 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13130 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13131 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013132 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13133 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13134 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13135 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013136 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013137 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13138 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013139
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013140 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13141 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13142 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13143 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13144 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013145 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013146
13147 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13148 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013149 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013150 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13151 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13152
13153 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013154 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13155 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13156 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013157
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013158 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013159 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013160
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013161
13162timeout queue <timeout>
13163 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13165 yes | no | yes | yes
13166 Arguments :
13167 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13168 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13169 as explained at the top of this document.
13170
13171 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13172 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13173 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13174 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13175 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13176
13177 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13178 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13179 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13180 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13181
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013182 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013183
13184
13185timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013186 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13188 yes | no | yes | yes
13189 Arguments :
13190 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13191 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13192 as explained at the top of this document.
13193
13194 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13195 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13196 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13197 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13198 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13199 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13200 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13201
13202 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13203 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13204 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13205 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13206 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013207 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013208 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013209 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13210 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013211 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13212 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013213
13214 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13215 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13216 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13217 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013218 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013219 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13220
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013221 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013222
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013223
13224timeout server-fin <timeout>
13225 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13227 yes | no | yes | yes
13228 Arguments :
13229 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13230 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13231 as explained at the top of this document.
13232
13233 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13234 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13235 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13236 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13237 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13238 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13239 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13240 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13241 situations, it should not be needed.
13242
13243 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13244 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13245 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13246
13247 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13248
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013249
13250timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013251 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13253 yes | yes | yes | yes
13254 Arguments :
13255 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13257 as explained at the top of this document.
13258
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013259 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13260 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13261 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013262
13263 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13264 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13265 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13266 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013267 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013268
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013269 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013270
13271
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013272timeout tunnel <timeout>
13273 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13275 yes | no | yes | yes
13276 Arguments :
13277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13279 as explained at the top of this document.
13280
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013281 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013282 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13283 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13284 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013285 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13286 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013287 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13288 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13289 specified.
13290
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013291 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13292 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13293 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13294 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13295 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13296 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13297 state.
13298
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013299 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13300 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13301 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13302 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013304
13305 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13306 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13307 forget about it.
13308
13309 Example :
13310 defaults http
13311 option http-server-close
13312 timeout connect 5s
13313 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013314 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013315 timeout server 30s
13316 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13317
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013318 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013319
13320
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013321transparent (deprecated)
13322 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013324 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013325 Arguments : none
13326
13327 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13328 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13329 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13330 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13331 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13332 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13333 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13334 appropriate server.
13335
13336 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13337
13338 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13339 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13340
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013341 See also: "option transparent"
13342
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013343unique-id-format <string>
13344 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13346 yes | yes | yes | no
13347 Arguments :
13348 <string> is a log-format string.
13349
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013350 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13351 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13352 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13353 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013354
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013355 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013356 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013357 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13358 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13359 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13360 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13361 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13362 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013363
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013364 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13365 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013366
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013367 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013368
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013369 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013370
13371 will generate:
13372
13373 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13374
13375 See also: "unique-id-header"
13376
13377unique-id-header <name>
13378 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13380 yes | yes | yes | no
13381 Arguments :
13382 <name> is the name of the header.
13383
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013384 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13385 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013386
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013387 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013388
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013389 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013390 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13391
13392 will generate:
13393
13394 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13395
13396 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013397
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013398use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013399 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13401 no | yes | yes | no
13402 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013403 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13404 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013405
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013406 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13407 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013408
13409 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13410 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13411 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013412 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013414 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13415 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013416
13417 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13418 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13419 assign the backend.
13420
13421 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13422 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13423 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13424 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13425 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13426 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13427
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013428 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013429 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013430 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13431 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13432 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13433
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013434 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13435 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13436 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13437 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13438 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13439 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13440 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13441 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13442 cannot be forced from the request.
13443
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013444 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013445 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13446 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13447
13448 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13449 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013450
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013451use-fcgi-app <name>
13452 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13454 no | no | yes | yes
13455 Arguments :
13456 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13457
13458 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013459
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013460use-server <server> if <condition>
13461use-server <server> unless <condition>
13462 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13464 no | no | yes | yes
13465 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013466 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13467 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013468
13469 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13470
13471 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13472 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13473 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13474
13475 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13476 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13477 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13478 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13479 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13480 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13481 matches will assign the server.
13482
13483 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13484 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13485 with the next rules until one matches.
13486
13487 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13488 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13489 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13490 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13491
13492 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13493 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13494 stripped.
13495
13496 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13497 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013498 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013499 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013500 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013501
13502 Example :
13503 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013504 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013505 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013506 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013507 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013508 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013509 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013510 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13511 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13512
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013513 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13514 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13515 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13516 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013517 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013518 and we fall back to load balancing.
13519
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013520 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013521
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013522
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135235. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013524--------------------------
13525
13526The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13527depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13528settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13529written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13530described in this section.
13531
13532
135335.1. Bind options
13534-----------------
13535
13536The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13537as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13538no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13539parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13540while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13541provided immediately after the setting name.
13542
13543The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13544
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013545accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13546 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13547 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13548 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13549 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13550 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13551 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13552 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13553 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13554 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013555 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13556 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13557 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013558
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013559accept-proxy
13560 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013561 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13562 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013563 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13564 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13565 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13566 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013567 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013568 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13569 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013570 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13571 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013572
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013573allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013574 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013575 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013576 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013577 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13578 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013579
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013580alpn <protocols>
13581 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13582 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13583 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013584 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013585 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013586 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13587 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13588 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13589 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13590 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13591 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13592 preference, like below :
13593
13594 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013595
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013596backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013597 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013598 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13599
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013600curves <curves>
13601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13602 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13603 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13604 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13605 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13606 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13607
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013608ecdhe <named curve>
13609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013610 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13611 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013612
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013613ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13615 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13616 client's certificate.
13617
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013618ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13620 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13621 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13622 error is ignored.
13623
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013624ca-sign-file <cafile>
13625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13626 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13627 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13628 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13629 'generate-certificates' for details.
13630
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013631ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013632 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13633 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13634 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13635 'generate-certificates' for details.
13636
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013637ca-verify-file <cafile>
13638 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13639 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13640 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13641 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13642 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13643
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013644ciphers <ciphers>
13645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13646 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013647 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013648 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013649 information and recommendations see e.g.
13650 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13651 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13652 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13653
13654ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13656 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13657 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13658 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013659 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13660 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013661
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013662crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013663 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13664 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013665 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13666 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013667
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013668crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13670 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13671 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13672 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13673 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013674 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13675 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013676
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013677 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13678 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13679
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013680 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13681 are loaded.
13682
13683 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013684 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13685 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13686 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13687 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13688 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13689 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13690 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013691 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013692
13693 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13694 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13695 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13696 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013697 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13698 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013699
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013700 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013701
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013702 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013703 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013704 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13705 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013706 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13707 clients).
13708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013709 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013710 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13711 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13712 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13713 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13714 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13715 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13716 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13717 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13718 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13719 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13720 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13721 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13722
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013723 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013724 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13725 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13726 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13727 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13728
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013729 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13730 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13731 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13732 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013733
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013734 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13735 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13736 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013737
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013738crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013740 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013741 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013742 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013743
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013744crt-list <file>
13745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013746 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13747 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013748
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013749 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13750
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013751 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13752 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13753 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13754 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13755 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013756
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013757 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013758 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13759 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13760 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13761 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13762 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013763 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13764 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13765 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013766
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013767 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13768 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13769 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013770
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013771 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13772
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013773 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013774 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013775 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13776 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13777 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13778 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13779 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13780 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013781
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013782 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013783 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013784 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013785 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013786 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013787 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013788
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013789defer-accept
13790 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13791 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13792 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013793 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013794 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13795 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13796 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13797 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13798 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13799 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13800 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13801
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013802expose-fd listeners
13803 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13804 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013805 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13806 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013807 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013808
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013809force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013810 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013811 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013812 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013813 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013814
13815force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013816 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013817 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013818 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013819
13820force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013821 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013822 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013823 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013824
13825force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013826 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013827 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013828 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013829
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013830force-tlsv13
13831 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13832 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013833 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013834
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013835generate-certificates
13836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13837 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13838 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13839 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13840 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13841 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13842 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13843 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13844 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13845 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13846 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13847
13848 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13849 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013850 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013851 certificate is used many times.
13852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013853gid <gid>
13854 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13855 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13856 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13857 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13858 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13859
13860group <group>
13861 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13862 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13863 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13864 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13865 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13866
13867id <id>
13868 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13869 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13870 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13871 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13872
13873interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013874 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13875 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13876 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13877 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13878 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13879 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013880 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13881 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13882 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13883 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13884 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13885 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013886
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013887level <level>
13888 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13889 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13890 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013891 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013892 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13893 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13894 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013895 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013896 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013897 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013898 all counters).
13899
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013900severity-output <format>
13901 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13902 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13903 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13904 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13905 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13906 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13907 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13908 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13909 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13910 rfc5424 convention.
13911
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013912maxconn <maxconn>
13913 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13914 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13915 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13916 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13917 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13918 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13919 eat all memory.
13920
13921mode <mode>
13922 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13923 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13924 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13925 UNIX sockets.
13926
13927mss <maxseg>
13928 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13929 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13930 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13931 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13932 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13933 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13934 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13935 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13936 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13937 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13938 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13939
13940name <name>
13941 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13942 page.
13943
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013944namespace <name>
13945 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13946 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13947 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13948 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13949
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013950nice <nice>
13951 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13952 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13953 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13954 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13955 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13956 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13957 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13958 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13959 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13960 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13961 one for an RDP socket.
13962
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013963no-ca-names
13964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13965 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013966 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013967
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013968no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013970 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013971 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013972 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013973 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13974 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013975
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013976no-tls-tickets
13977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13978 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13979 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013980 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13981 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013982 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13983 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13984 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013985
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013986no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013988 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013989 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013990 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013991 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13992 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013993
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013994no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013996 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013997 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013998 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013999 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14000 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014001
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014002no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014004 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014005 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014006 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014007 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14008 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014009
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014010no-tlsv13
14011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14012 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14013 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14014 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014015 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14016 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014017
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014018npn <protocols>
14019 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14020 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14021 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014022 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014023 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014024 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14025 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14026 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14027 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14028 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014029
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014030prefer-client-ciphers
14031 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14032 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14033 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014034 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14035 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14036 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014037
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014038process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014039 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14040 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14041 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14042 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14043 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14044 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014045
14046 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14047
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014048 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014049 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14050 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14051 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14052 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14053 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014054
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014055 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14056 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14057
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014058proto <name>
14059 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14060 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14061 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014062 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14063 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14064
14065 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14066 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14067 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14068 also reported (flag=HTX).
14069
14070 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14071 a bind line :
14072
14073 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14074 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14075 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14076
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014077 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014078 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014079 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014080 h2" on the bind line.
14081
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014082shards <number> | by-thread
14083 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14084 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14085 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14086 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14087 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14088 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14089 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14090 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14091 little bit.
14092
14093 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14094 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14095 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14096 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14097 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14098 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014100ssl
14101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014102 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014103 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14104 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014105 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14106 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014107
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014108ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14109 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014110 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14111 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14112 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14114
14115ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014116 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14117 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14118 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14119 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014120
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014121strict-sni
14122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14123 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14124 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14125 See the "crt" option for more information.
14126
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014127tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014128 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014129 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014130 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014131 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014132 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14133 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14134 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14135 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14136 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14137 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14138 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14139
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014140tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014141 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014142 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14143 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14144 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14145 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14146 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14147 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14148 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014149 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14150 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14151 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014152
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014153thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014154 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14155 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14156 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014157
14158 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14159 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14160 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14161 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14162 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14163 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14164 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14165 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14166 of the parsing.
14167
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014168 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014169 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14170 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014171
14172 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14173
14174 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14175 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14176 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14177 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14178 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14179 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14180
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014181tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14182 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014183 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14184 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14185 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14186 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14187 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14188 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14189 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14190 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14191 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14192 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014193 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14194 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14195
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014196transparent
14197 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14198 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14199 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14200 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14201 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14202 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14203 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14204 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14205 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14206 so check for support with your vendor.
14207
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014208v4v6
14209 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14210 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14211 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14212 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014213 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014214
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014215v6only
14216 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14217 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14218 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014219 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14220 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014221
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014222uid <uid>
14223 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14224 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14225 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14226 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14227 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14228
14229user <user>
14230 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14231 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14232 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14233 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14234 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14235
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014236verify [none|optional|required]
14237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14238 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14239 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14240 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14241 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014242 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14243 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14244 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14245 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014246
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200142475.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014248------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014250The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14251which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14252arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14253settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14254after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14255Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14256address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014258 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014259 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014260
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014261Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14262keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014264The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014265
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014266addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014267 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014268 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14269 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14270 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14271 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14272 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014273
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014274agent-check
14275 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014276 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014277 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14278 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14279 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014280
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014281 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014282 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014283 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014284 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14285 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014287 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14288 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14289 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14290 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14291 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014292
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014293 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014294 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014295
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014296 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14297 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14298 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014299
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014300 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14301 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14302 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014303
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014304 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014305 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14306 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14307 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14308 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014309 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014310 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014311
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014312 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14313 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014314
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014315 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14316 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14317 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14318 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14319 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14320 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14321 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14322 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14323 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014324
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014325 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14326 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014327 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14328 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14329 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014330 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014331
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014332 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014333 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014334
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014335agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014336 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014337 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14338 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14339 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14340 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14341
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014342agent-inter <delay>
14343 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14344 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14345
14346 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14347 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14348 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14349 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14350 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14351 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14352 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14353 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14354 of backends use the same servers.
14355
14356 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14357
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014358agent-addr <addr>
14359 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14360
14361 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014362 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014363 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14364 hostname, it will be resolved.
14365
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014366agent-port <port>
14367 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14368
14369 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14370
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014371allow-0rtt
14372 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014373 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14374 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014375
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014376alpn <protocols>
14377 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14378 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14379 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014380 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014381 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14382 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14383 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14384 now obsolete NPN extension.
14385 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14386 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14387
14388 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014390backup
14391 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14392 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14393 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14394 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014395 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14396 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014397
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014398ca-file <cafile>
14399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14400 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14401 server's certificate.
14402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014403check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014404 This option enables health checks on a server:
14405 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14406 considered available.
14407 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14408 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14409 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14410 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14411 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14412 set.
14413 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14414 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14415 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14416 exchanges succeed.
14417
14418 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14419 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14420 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14421 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14422 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014423 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014424 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14425
14426 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14427 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14428
14429 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14430 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14431
14432 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14433 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14434 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14435 available.
14436
14437 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14438 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14439 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14440
14441 Example:
14442 # simple tcp check
14443 backend foo
14444 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14445 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14446 backend foo
14447 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14448 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14449 backend foo
14450 option tcp-check
14451 tcp-check connect
14452 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014453
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014454check-send-proxy
14455 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14456 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14457 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14458 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14459 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14460 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14461 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14462
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014463check-alpn <protocols>
14464 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14465 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14466 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14467
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014468check-proto <name>
14469 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14470 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14471 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014472 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14473 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14474
14475 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14476 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14477 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14478 also reported (flag=HTX).
14479
14480 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14481 directive on a server line:
14482
14483 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14484 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14485 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14486 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14487
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014488 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014489 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14490 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14491
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014492check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014493 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014494 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14495 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014496
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014497check-ssl
14498 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14499 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14500 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14501 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014502 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014503 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14504 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014505 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014506 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14507 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014508
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014509check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014510 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014511 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14512 for normal traffic.
14513
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014514ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14516 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14517 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014518 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14519 information and recommendations see e.g.
14520 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14521 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14522 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014523
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014524ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14525 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14526 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14527 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14528 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014529 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14530 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14531 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014533cookie <value>
14534 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14535 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14536 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14537 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14538 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14539 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14540 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14541
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014542crl-file <crlfile>
14543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14544 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14545 to verify server's certificate.
14546
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014547crt <cert>
14548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14549 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14550 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14551 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14552 certificate request.
14553
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014554 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14555 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14556 option is set accordingly).
14557
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014558disabled
14559 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14560 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14561 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14562 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14563 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014564 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014565
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014566enabled
14567 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14568 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14569 default value.
14570 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14571 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014573error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014574 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14575 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14576 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014578 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014580fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014581 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14582 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14583 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14584
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014585force-sslv3
14586 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14587 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014588 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014589 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014590
14591force-tlsv10
14592 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014593 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014594 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014595
14596force-tlsv11
14597 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014598 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014599 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014600
14601force-tlsv12
14602 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014603 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014604 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014605
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014606force-tlsv13
14607 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14608 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014609 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014611id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014612 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14613 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14614 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014615
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014616init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14617 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14618 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014619 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014620 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14621 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14622 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14623 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14624 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14625 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14626 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14627 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14628 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014629 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014630 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14631 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14632 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14633 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14634 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14635 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014636 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014637
14638 Example:
14639 defaults
14640 # never fail on address resolution
14641 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014643inter <delay>
14644fastinter <delay>
14645downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014646 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14647 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14648 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14649 between checks depending on the server state :
14650
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014651 Server state | Interval used
14652 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14653 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14654 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14655 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14656 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14657 or yet unchecked. |
14658 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14659 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14660 | "inter" otherwise.
14661 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014663 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14664 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14665 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14666 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014667 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14668 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14669 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14670 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14671 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014672
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014673log-proto <logproto>
14674 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14675 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14676 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14677 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014679maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014680 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14681 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014682 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14683 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014684 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14685 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14686 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14687 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14688
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014689 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14690 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14691 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14692 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14693 than 50 concurrent requests.
14694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014695maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014696 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14697 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14698 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14699 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014700 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14701 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14702 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14703 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14704 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14705 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14706 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014707
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014708max-reuse <count>
14709 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14710 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14711 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14712 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14713 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14714 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14715 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14716 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014718minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014719 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14720 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14721 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14722 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14723 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14724 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014725 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014726 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014727
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014728namespace <name>
14729 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14730 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14731 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14732 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14733
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014734no-agent-check
14735 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14736 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14737 default value.
14738 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14739 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14740
14741no-backup
14742 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14743 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14744 default value.
14745 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14746 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14747
14748no-check
14749 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14750 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14751 default value.
14752 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14753 "default-server" "check" setting.
14754
14755no-check-ssl
14756 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14757 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14758 default value.
14759 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14760 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14761
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014762no-send-proxy
14763 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14764 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14765 default value.
14766 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14767 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14768
14769no-send-proxy-v2
14770 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14771 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14772 default value.
14773 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14774 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14775
14776no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14777 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14778 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14779 default value.
14780 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14781 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14782
14783no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14784 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14785 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14786 default value.
14787 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14788 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14789
14790no-ssl
14791 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14792 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14793 default value.
14794 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14795 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14796
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014797 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14798 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14799 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14800
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014801no-ssl-reuse
14802 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14803 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14804 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14805 and for paranoid users.
14806
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014807no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014808 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14809 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014810 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014811
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014812 Supported in default-server: No
14813
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014814no-tls-tickets
14815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14816 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14817 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014818 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14819 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014820 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14821 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14822 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014823 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014824
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014825no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014826 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014827 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14828 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014829 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14830 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014831 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014832
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014833 Supported in default-server: No
14834
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014835no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014836 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014837 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14838 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014839 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14840 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014841 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014842
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014843 Supported in default-server: No
14844
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014845no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014846 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014847 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14848 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014849 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14850 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014851 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014852
14853 Supported in default-server: No
14854
14855no-tlsv13
14856 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14857 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14858 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14859 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14860 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014861 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014862
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014863 Supported in default-server: No
14864
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014865no-verifyhost
14866 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14867 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14868 default value.
14869 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14870 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014871
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014872no-tfo
14873 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14874 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14875 default value.
14876 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14877 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14878
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014879non-stick
14880 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14881 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14882 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14883
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014884npn <protocols>
14885 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14886 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14887 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014888 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014889 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14890 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14891 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014893observe <mode>
14894 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14895 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14896 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14897 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14898 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14899 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014900 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014901
14902 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014904on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014905 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14906 Currently, four modes are available:
14907 - fastinter: force fastinter
14908 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14909 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14910 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14911 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14912
14913 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14914
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014915on-marked-down <action>
14916 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14917 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014918 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14919 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14920 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14921 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14922 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14923 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14924 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14925 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014926
14927 Actions are disabled by default
14928
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014929on-marked-up <action>
14930 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14931 Currently one action is available:
14932 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14933 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14934 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14935 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014936 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14937 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014938 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14939 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14940
14941 Actions are disabled by default
14942
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014943pool-low-conn <max>
14944 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14945 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14946 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14947 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14948 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14949 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14950 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14951 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14952 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14953 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014954 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14955 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14956 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14957 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014958
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014959pool-max-conn <max>
14960 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14961 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14962 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14963 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14964 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14965 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14966
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014967pool-purge-delay <delay>
14968 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014969 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014970 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014972port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014973 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014974 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14975 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14976 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14977 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14978 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014979
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014980proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014981 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14982 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14983 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014984 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14985 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14986
14987 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14988 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14989 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14990 also reported (flag=HTX).
14991
14992 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14993 a server line :
14994
14995 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14996 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14997 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14998 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14999
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015000 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015001 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015003redir <prefix>
15004 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15005 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15006 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15007 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15008 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15009 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15010 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15011 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015012 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015013 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015014 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15015 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15016 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15017 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15018
15019 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015021rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015022 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15023 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15024 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15025
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015026resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15027 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15028 server.
15029
15030 Available options:
15031
15032 * allow-dup-ip
15033 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15034 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15035 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15036 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15037 For such case, simply enable this option.
15038 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15039
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015040 * ignore-weight
15041 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15042 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15043 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15044
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015045 * prevent-dup-ip
15046 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15047 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15048 same fqdn.
15049 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15050
15051 Example:
15052 backend b_myapp
15053 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15054 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15055 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15056
15057 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15058 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15059 it
15060 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15061 different address
15062
15063 Default value: not set
15064
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015065resolve-prefer <family>
15066 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15067 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15068 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15069 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15070
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015071 Default value: ipv6
15072
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015073 Example:
15074
15075 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015076
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015077resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015078 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015079 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015080 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015081 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15082 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015083 configured network, another address is selected.
15084
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015085 Example:
15086
15087 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015088
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015089resolvers <id>
15090 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15091 hostname.
15092
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015093 Example:
15094
15095 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015096
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015097 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015098
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015099send-proxy
15100 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15101 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15102 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15103 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015104 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15105 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15106 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15107 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015108 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015109 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15110 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15111 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15112 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15113 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015114 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15115 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015116
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015117send-proxy-v2
15118 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15119 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15120 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15121 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015122 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15123 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15124 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15125 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015126
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015127proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015128 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15129 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15130
15131 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15132 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15133 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15134 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15135 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15136 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15137 connection is supported).
15138 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15139 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15140 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15141 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15142 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15143 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15144 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015145
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015146send-proxy-v2-ssl
15147 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15148 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15149 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15150 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15151 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15152 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15153 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015154 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15155 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015156
15157send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15158 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15159 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15160 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15161 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15162 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15163 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15164 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15165 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015166 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15167 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015169slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015170 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15171 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15172 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15173 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15174 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15175 parameters :
15176
15177 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15178 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15179
15180 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15181 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15182 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15183 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15184
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015185 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15187 seen as failed.
15188
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015189sni <expression>
15190 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15191 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15192 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15193 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015194 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15195 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015196 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015197 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15198 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015199
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015200source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015201source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015202source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015203 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15204 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15205 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15206 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15207
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015208 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15209 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15210 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15211 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15212 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15213 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15214 server.
15215
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015216 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15217 specifying the source address without port(s).
15218
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015219ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015220 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15221 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15222 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15223 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15224 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15225 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015226 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15227 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015228
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015229ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15230 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15231 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15232 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15233
15234ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15235 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15236 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15237 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15238
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015239ssl-reuse
15240 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15241 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15242 default value.
15243 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15244 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15245
15246stick
15247 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15248 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15249 default value.
15250 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15251 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015252
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015253socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015254 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015255 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15256 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15257
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015258tcp-ut <delay>
15259 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015260 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015261 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015262 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015263 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15264 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15265 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15266 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15267 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15268 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15269 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15270 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15271 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15272
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015273tfo
15274 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15275 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15276 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15277 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015278 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015279 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015281track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015282 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15283 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15284 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15285 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015286 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15287
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015288tls-tickets
15289 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15290 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15291 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015292 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15293 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15294 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015295 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015296 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015297
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015298verify [none|required]
15299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015300 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015301 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15302 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015303 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015304 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15305 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15306 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15307 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15308 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15309 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15310 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15311 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015312
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015313verifyhost <hostname>
15314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015315 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15316 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15317 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15318 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15319 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15320 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15321 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15322 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015323
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015324weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015325 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15326 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15327 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015328 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15329 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15330 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15331 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15332 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15333 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015334
15335
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153365.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15337-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015338
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015339HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15340using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015341configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015342This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15343can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15344workload.
15345This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15346resolution at run time.
15347Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15348carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15349
15350
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153515.3.1. Global overview
15352----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015353
15354As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15355different steps of the process life:
15356
15357 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15358 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15359 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15360
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015361 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15362 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015363
15364A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15365 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15366 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15367 resolution to know this new IP.
15368
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015369When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015371SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15372from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015373will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015374will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015375
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015376A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015377 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015378 first valid response.
15379
15380 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15381 servers return an error.
15382
15383
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153845.3.2. The resolvers section
15385----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015386
15387This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015388HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15389contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015390
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015391When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15392uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15393is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15394answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15395
15396When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015397used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015398
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015399 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15400 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15401 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015402
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015403 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15404 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015405
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015406 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15407 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15408 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015409
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015410For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15411following scenarios are possible:
15412
15413 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15414 ignored
15415
15416 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15417 applied
15418
15419 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15420 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15421
15422 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15423 retries the query with a new type
15424
15425 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15426 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015427
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015428As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015429a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015430<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015431
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015432
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015433resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015434 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015435
15436A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15437
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015438accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015439 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015440 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015441 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15442 by RFC 6891)
15443
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015444 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15445 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15446 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15447 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15448 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15449 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015450
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015451nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15452 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15453 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15454 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15455 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15456 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15457 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15458 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15459 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15460 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015461 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15462
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015463parse-resolv-conf
15464 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15465 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15466 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15467
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015468hold <status> <period>
15469 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15470 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015471 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015472 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015473 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15474 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15475 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15476
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015477 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015478
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015479resolve_retries <nb>
15480 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15481 giving up.
15482 Default value: 3
15483
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015484 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15485 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15486 type.
15487
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015488timeout <event> <time>
15489 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15490 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15491 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015492 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15493 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015494 Default value: 1s
15495 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015496 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015497 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015498 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15499 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15500
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015501 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015502
15503 resolvers mydns
15504 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15505 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015506 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015507 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015508 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015509 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015510 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015511 hold other 30s
15512 hold refused 30s
15513 hold nx 30s
15514 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015515 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015516 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015517
15518
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200155196. Cache
15520---------
15521
15522HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15523(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15524RAM.
15525
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015526The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15527blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015528
15529If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15530independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15531when we try to allocate a new one.
15532
15533The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15534
15535It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15536"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15537for more details.
15538
15539When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15540replaced by "<CACHE>".
15541
15542
155436.1. Limitation
15544----------------
15545
15546The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15547
15548- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015549- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15550 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15551 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015552- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15553- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015554- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15555 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15556 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015557- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15558 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015559- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15560 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15561 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015562
15563- If the request is not a GET
15564- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15565- If the request contains an Authorization header
15566
15567
155686.2. Setup
15569-----------
15570
15571To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15572the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15573
15574
155756.2.1. Cache section
15576---------------------
15577
15578cache <name>
15579 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15580 size of cache is mandatory.
15581
15582total-max-size <megabytes>
15583 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15584 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15585
15586max-object-size <bytes>
15587 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15588 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15589 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15590
15591max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015592 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015593 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15594 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15595 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15596 default.
15597
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015598process-vary <on/off>
15599 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015600 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15601 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15602 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015603 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015604
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015605max-secondary-entries <number>
15606 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15607 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15608 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15609
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015610
156116.2.2. Proxy section
15612---------------------
15613
15614http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15615 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15616 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15617 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15618 after this one.
15619
15620http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15621 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15622 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15623 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15624 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15625
15626
15627Example:
15628
15629 backend bck1
15630 mode http
15631
15632 http-request cache-use foobar
15633 http-response cache-store foobar
15634 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15635
15636 cache foobar
15637 total-max-size 4
15638 max-age 240
15639
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156417. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15642----------------------------------
15643
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015644HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15646The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15647these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15648but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15649data called patterns.
15650
15651
156527.1. ACL basics
15653---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015654
15655The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15656content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15657from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15658simple :
15659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015661 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15663 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15666adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015667
15668In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015671
15672This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15673Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15674and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015675an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15676conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15677as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15678are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015679
15680ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15681'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15682which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15683
15684There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15685performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15688specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15689this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015690methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15691ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692
15693Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15694 - boolean
15695 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15696 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15697 - string
15698 - data block
15699
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015700Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15701converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15702would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15703The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15704which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15705
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015706Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15707keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15708fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15709which are summarized in the table below :
15710
15711 +---------------------+-----------------+
15712 | Sample or converter | Default |
15713 | output type | matching method |
15714 +---------------------+-----------------+
15715 | boolean | bool |
15716 +---------------------+-----------------+
15717 | integer | int |
15718 +---------------------+-----------------+
15719 | ip | ip |
15720 +---------------------+-----------------+
15721 | string | str |
15722 +---------------------+-----------------+
15723 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15724 +---------------------+-----------------+
15725
15726Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15727matching method, see below.
15728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15730 - boolean
15731 - integer or integer range
15732 - IP address / network
15733 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15734 - regular expression
15735 - hex block
15736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015737The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15738
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015739 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15740 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015742 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015743 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015744 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015745 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15748read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15749if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15750lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15751will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15752beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015753a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15755exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15756
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015757The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15758parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15759ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15760a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15761check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15762
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015763The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15764socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15765file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15768loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15769
15770 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15771
15772In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15773the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15774case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15775as well.
15776
15777The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15778sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15779do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15780methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15781is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015782obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15784default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15785that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15786string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15787
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015788The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15789By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15790string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15791resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015792server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015793waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015794flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15795function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15798sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15799be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015800
15801 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15802 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15804 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15805 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15806 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015807
15808 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15809 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015811
15812 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015814
15815 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015818 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015819 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15820
15821 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15822 binary or string samples.
15823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15825 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015827 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15828 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15829 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15832 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15835 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15838 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15841 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015842 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15845 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15846 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015847
15848For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15849request, it is possible to do :
15850
15851 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15852
15853In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15854buffer, one would use the following acl :
15855
15856 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15857
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015858On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15859possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15860
15861 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15864criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15865method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15866to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15867criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15868the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015871the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15872For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15875 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15876 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15877 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015878
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015879
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015880The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15881types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15882combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15883brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15884default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886 +-------------------------------------------------+
15887 | Input sample type |
15888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015889 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15891 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015893 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015895 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015897 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015899 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015901 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015903 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015905 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015907 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015909 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015911 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015913 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15915 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015917
15918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159197.1.1. Matching booleans
15920------------------------
15921
15922In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15923Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15924When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15925that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15926
15927Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15928return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15929"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159327.1.2. Matching integers
15933------------------------
15934
15935Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15936enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15937to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15938
15939Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15940matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15941lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015942
15943For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15944unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15945representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15946
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015947As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15948two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15949instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15950ranges and operators.
15951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015952For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015953operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15954Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15955of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015957Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015958
15959 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15960 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15961 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15962 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15963 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015965For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015966
15967 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15968
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015969This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15970
15971 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159747.1.3. Matching strings
15975-----------------------
15976
15977String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15978different forms :
15979
15980 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015981 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982
15983 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015984 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985
15986 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15987 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15988
15989 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15990 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15991
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015992 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15994 matches.
15995
15996 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15997 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15998 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015999
16000String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16001exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16002characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16003string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16004to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016005before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016006
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016007Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16008(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16009Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16010
16011Example:
16012 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16013 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16014
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160167.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16017---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016018
16019Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16020they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16021possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16022passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16023the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016024the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16025match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016026
16027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160287.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16029-------------------------------------
16030
16031It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16032not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16033a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16034to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16035digits may be used upper or lower case.
16036
16037Example :
16038 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
16039 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
16040
16041
160427.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16043---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016044
16045IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16046netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16047within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016048host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016049difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16050at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16051does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16052parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016053
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016054The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16055abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16056
16057 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16058 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16059 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16060 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16061 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16062 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16063 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16064 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16065
16066Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16067192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16068
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016069IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16070Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16071trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16072IPv6 patterns.
16073
16074HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16075following situations :
16076 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16077 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16078 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16079 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16080 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16081 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16082 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16083 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16084 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16085 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087
160887.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16089----------------------------------
16090
16091Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16092combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16093
16094 - AND (implicit)
16095 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16096 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16103indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16106"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16107requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16108is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16109
16110 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016111 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16112 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16113 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114
16115To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16116and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16117
16118 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16119 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16120 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16121 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016123 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16125 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16126 use_backend www if host_www
16127
16128It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16129expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16130be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16131the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16132
16133 The following rule :
16134
16135 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016136 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137
16138 Can also be written that way :
16139
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016140 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141
16142It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16143to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16144simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16145sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16146good use is the following :
16147
16148 With named ACLs :
16149
16150 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16151 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16152 monitor fail if site_dead
16153
16154 With anonymous ACLs :
16155
16156 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16157
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016158See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16159keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160
16161
161627.3. Fetching samples
16163---------------------
16164
16165Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16166against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16167sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16168ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16169of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16170available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16171
16172This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16173Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16174compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16175deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16176
16177The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16178matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16179method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16180indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16181
16182As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16183when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16184mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16185the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16186ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16187
16188Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16189multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16190when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016191incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16192are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16194all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16195
16196Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16197 - name
16198 - name(arg1)
16199 - name(arg1,arg2)
16200
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016201
162027.3.1. Converters
16203-----------------
16204
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016205Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16206of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16207is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16208was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016209has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016210unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16211
16212These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16213sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16214the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016215support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016216
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016217A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16218support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16219supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16220(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16221bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016224
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001622551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16226 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16227 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16228 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16229 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16230 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16231
16232 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016233 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16234 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016235 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16236 frontend http-in
16237 bind *:8081
16238 default_backend servers
16239 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16240 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16241
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016242add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016243 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016244 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016245 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16246 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16250 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16251 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016253 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016254
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016255aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16256 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16257 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16258 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16259 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16260 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16261 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16262
16263 Example:
16264 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16265 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16266
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016267and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016268 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016269 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016270 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16271 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016272 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016273 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16274 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16275 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16276 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016277 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016278 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016279
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016280b64dec
16281 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16282 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016283 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16284 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016285
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016286base64
16287 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016288 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016289 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16290 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016291
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016292be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16293 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16294 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16295 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16296 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16297 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16298
16299 Example:
16300 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16301 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16302 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16303 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16304
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016305be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16306 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16307 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16308 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16309 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16310 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16311 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16312
16313 Example:
16314 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16315 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16316 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16317 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16318
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016319bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016320 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016321 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016322 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016323 presence of a flag).
16324
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016325bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16326 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16327 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016328 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016329
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016330concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16331 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16332 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16333 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16334 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16335 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16336 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16337 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16338 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16339 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16340 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016341 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016342 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016343 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016344 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16345 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16346 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016347
16348 Example:
16349 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16350 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16351 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016352 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016353 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016354 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16355
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016356cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016357 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16358 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016359
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016360crc32([<avalanche>])
16361 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16362 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16363 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16364 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16365 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16366 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16367 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16368 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16369 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16370 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016371 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16372
16373crc32c([<avalanche>])
16374 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16375 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16376 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16377 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16378 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16379 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16380 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16381 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016382
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016383cut_crlf
16384 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16385 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16386 updated.
16387
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016388da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016389 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16390 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16391 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16392 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016393 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016394 configuration language.
16395
16396 Example:
16397 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016398 bind *:8881
16399 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016400 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016401
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016402debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16403 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16404 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16405 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16406 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16407 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16408 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16409 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16410 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16411 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16412 printable sample types.
16413
16414 Example:
16415 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016416
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016417digest(<algorithm>)
16418 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16419 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16420
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016421 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016422 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16423
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016424div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016425 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16426 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016427 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016428 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16429 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016430 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016431 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16432 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16433 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16434 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016435 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016436 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016437
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016438djb2([<avalanche>])
16439 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16440 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16441 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16442 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16443 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16444 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16445 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016446 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16447 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016448
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016449even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016450 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016451 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16452
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016453field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16454 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16455 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16456 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16457 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16458 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16459 fields.
16460
16461 Example :
16462 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16463 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16464 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16465 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16466 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016467
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016468fix_is_valid
16469 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16470 Information eXchange):
16471
16472 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16473 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016474 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016475 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016476 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016477 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16478 checksum
16479
16480 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16481 the server can be parsed.
16482
16483 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16484 message, false if not.
16485
16486 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16487
16488 Example:
16489 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16490 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16491
16492fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16493 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16494 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16495 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16496 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016497 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016498 added.
16499
16500 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16501 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16502 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16503 fix_is_valid converter.
16504
16505 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16506
16507 Example:
16508 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16509 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16510 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16511 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16512 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016514hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016515 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016516 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016517 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016518 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016519
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016520hex2i
16521 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016522 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016523
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016524htonl
16525 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16526 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16527 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16528 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16529
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016530hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016531 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16532 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16533 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16534 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16535
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016536 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016537 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16538
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016539http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016540 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16541 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016542 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16543 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16544 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16545 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16546 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16547 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16548 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16549 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016551iif(<true>,<false>)
16552 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16553 string otherwise.
16554
16555 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016556 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016557
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016558in_table(<table>)
16559 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16560 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16561 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016562 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016563 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16564
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016565ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016566 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016567 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016568 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16569 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16570 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16571 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16572 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016573
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016574json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016575 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016576 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016577 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016578 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16579 of errors:
16580 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16581 bytes, ...)
16582 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16583 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16584
16585 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16586 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16587 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16588 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16589 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16590 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016591 - "ascii" : never fails;
16592 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16593 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016594 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016595 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016596 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16597 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16598
16599 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016600 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016601
16602 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016603 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016604 capture request header user-agent len 150
16605 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016606
16607 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16608 GET / HTTP/1.0
16609 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16610
16611 Output log:
16612 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16613
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016614json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16615 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16616 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16617 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16618 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16619
16620 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16621 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16622
16623 Example:
16624 # get a integer value from the request body
16625 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16626 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16627
16628 # get a key with '.' in the name
16629 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16630 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16631
16632 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16633 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16634
16635 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16636 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16637
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016638jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16639 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16640 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16641 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16642 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16643 json_path and output_type parameters.
16644
16645 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16646 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16647
16648jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16649 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16650 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16651 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16652 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16653 json_path and output_type parameters.
16654
16655 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16656 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16657
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016658jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16659 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16660 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016661 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016662 verification success. See below for a full list of the possible return
16663 values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016664
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016665 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16666 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16667 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16668 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016669
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016670 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16671 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16672 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16673 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16674 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16675 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
16676 be mentioned explicitely at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
16677 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16678
16679 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16680 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16681 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16682 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16683 contents.
16684
16685 The possible return values are the following :
16686
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016687 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16688 | ID | message |
16689 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16690 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
16691 | 1 | "Verification sucess" |
16692 | 2 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16693 | 3 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16694 | 4 | "Invalid token" |
16695 | 5 | "Out of memory" |
16696 | 6 | "Unknown certificate" |
16697 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016698
16699 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16700 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16701
16702 Example:
16703 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16704 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16705 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16706 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16707 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16708 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016710language(<value>[,<default>])
16711 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16712 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16713 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16714 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16715 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16716 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16717 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16718 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16719 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016720 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016721 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16722 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016724 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016725
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016726 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16727 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016729 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16730 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16731 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16732 use_backend spanish if es
16733 use_backend french if fr
16734 use_backend english if en
16735 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016736
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016737length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016738 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16739 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16740 type. The result is of type integer.
16741
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016742lower
16743 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16744 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16745 type. The result is of type string.
16746
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016747ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16748 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16749 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16750 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16751 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16752 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16753 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16754
16755 Example :
16756
16757 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016758 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016759 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16760
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016761ltrim(<chars>)
16762 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16763 representation of the input sample.
16764
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016765map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16766map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16767map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16768 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16769 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16770 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16771 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16772 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16773 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16774 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16775 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016776
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016777 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16778 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16779 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016780
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016781 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016782 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016783
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016784 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16785 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16786 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16787 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016788 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16789 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016790 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16791 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16792 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16793 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16794 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16795 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16796 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16797 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016798 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16799 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16800 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016801 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16802 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16803 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16804 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16805 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016806
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016807 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16808 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16809 the corresponding match text.
16810
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016811 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16812 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16813 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16814 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16815 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016816
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016817 Example :
16818
16819 # this is a comment and is ignored
16820 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16821 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16822 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16823 | | | `---------- value
16824 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16825 | `---------------------------- key
16826 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16827
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016828mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016829 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16830 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016831 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016832 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016833 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016834 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16835 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16836 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16837 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016838 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016839 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016840
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016841mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016842 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16843 <packettype>.
16844 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16845 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16846 from.
16847 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16848 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16849 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16850
16851 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16852 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16853 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16854 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16855
16856 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16857 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16858 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16859 packets only):
16860 17: Session Expiry Interval
16861 33: Receive Maximum
16862 39: Maximum Packet Size
16863 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16864 25: Request Response Information
16865 23: Request Problem Information
16866 21: Authentication Method
16867 22: Authentication Data
16868 18: Will Delay Interval
16869 1: Payload Format Indicator
16870 2: Message Expiry Interval
16871 3: Content Type
16872 8: Response Topic
16873 9: Correlation Data
16874 Not supported yet:
16875 38: User Property
16876
16877 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16878 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16879 packets only):
16880 17: Session Expiry Interval
16881 33: Receive Maximum
16882 36: Maximum QoS
16883 37: Retain Available
16884 39: Maximum Packet Size
16885 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16886 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16887 31: Reason String
16888 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16889 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16890 42: Shared Subscription Available
16891 19: Server Keep Alive
16892 26: Response Information
16893 28: Server Reference
16894 21: Authentication Method
16895 22: Authentication Data
16896 Not supported yet:
16897 38: User Property
16898
16899 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16900 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16901 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16902 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16903
16904 Example:
16905
16906 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16907 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16908 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16909 if data_in_buffer
16910 # do the same as above
16911 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16912 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16913 if data_in_buffer
16914
16915mqtt_is_valid
16916 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16917
16918 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16919 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16920 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16921 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16922
16923 Example:
16924
16925 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016926 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016927
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016928mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016929 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016930 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16931 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016932 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016933 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016934 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016935 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16936 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16937 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16938 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016939 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016940 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016941
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016942nbsrv
16943 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16944 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16945 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16946 map lookup.
16947
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016948neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016949 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16950 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16951 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16952 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016953
16954not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016955 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016956 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016957 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016958 absence of a flag).
16959
16960odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016961 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016962 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16963
16964or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016965 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016966 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016967 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16968 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016969 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016970 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16971 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16973 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016974 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016975 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016976
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016977protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16978 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16979 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16980 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16981 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16982 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16983 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16984 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16985 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16986 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16987 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16988 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16989
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016990regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016991 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16992 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16993 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16994 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16995 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16996 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16997 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16998 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16999 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017000 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17001 of characters with other ones.
17002
17003 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17004 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17005 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17006 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17007 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17008 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017009
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017010 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017011
17012 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17013 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17014 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017015 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017016
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017017 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17018 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17019
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017020 # capture groups and backreferences
17021 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017022 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017023 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17024
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017025capture-req(<id>)
17026 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17027 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17028
17029 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017030 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17031 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017032
17033capture-res(<id>)
17034 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17035 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17036
17037 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017038 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17039 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017040
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017041rtrim(<chars>)
17042 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17043 of the input sample.
17044
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017045sdbm([<avalanche>])
17046 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17047 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17048 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17049 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17050 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17051 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17052 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017053 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17054 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017055
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017056secure_memcmp(<var>)
17057 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17058 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17059 match.
17060
17061 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17062 performed in constant time.
17063
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017064 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017065 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17066
17067 Example :
17068
17069 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17070 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17071 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17072 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17073
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017074set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017075 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
17076 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
17077 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017078 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017079 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17080 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017081 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017082 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17083 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017085 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017086
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017087sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017088 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017089 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17090
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017091sha2([<bits>])
17092 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17093 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17094
17095 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17096 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17097
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017098 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017099 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17100
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017101srv_queue
17102 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17103 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17104 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17105 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17106 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17107
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017108strcmp(<var>)
17109 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17110 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17111 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17112 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17113 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17114 shorter).
17115
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017116 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17117 strings in constant time.
17118
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017119 Example :
17120
17121 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17122 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17123 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17124
17125
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017126sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017127 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17128 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017129 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017130 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17131 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017132 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017133 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17134 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017135 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017136 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17137 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017138 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017139 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017140
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017141table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17142 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17143 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17144 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17145 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17146 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17147 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17148
17149
17150table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17151 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17152 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17153 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17154 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17155 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17156 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17157
17158table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017161 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017162 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17163 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17164
17165table_conn_cur(<table>)
17166 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17167 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17168 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17169 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17170 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17171
17172table_conn_rate(<table>)
17173 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17174 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17175 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17176 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17177 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17178
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017179table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17180 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17181 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17182 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17183 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17184 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17185 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17186 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17187 data-type).
17188 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17189
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017190table_gpt0(<table>)
17191 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17192 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17193 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17194 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17195 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17196
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017197table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17198 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17199 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17200 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17201 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17202 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17203 between 0 and 99.
17204 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17205 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17206 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17207 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17208
17209table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17210 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17211 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17212 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17213 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17214 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17215 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17216 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17217 value 0.
17218 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17219 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17220 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17221
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017222table_gpc0(<table>)
17223 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17224 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17225 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17226 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17227 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17228
17229table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17230 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17231 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17232 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17233 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17234 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17235 sample fetch keyword.
17236
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017237table_gpc1(<table>)
17238 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17239 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17240 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17241 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17242 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17243
17244table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17245 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17246 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17247 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17248 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17249 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17250 sample fetch keyword.
17251
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017252table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017255 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017256 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17257 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17258
17259table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17260 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17261 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17262 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17263 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17264 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17265 keyword.
17266
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017267table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17268 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17269 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17270 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17271 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17272 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17273
17274table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17275 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17276 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17277 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17278 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17279 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17280 keyword.
17281
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017282table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17283 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17284 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017285 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017286 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17287 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17288
17289table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17292 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17293 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17294 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17295 keyword.
17296
17297table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17298 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17299 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017300 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017301 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17302 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17303 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17304 keyword.
17305
17306table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017309 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017310 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17311 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17312 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17313 keyword.
17314
17315table_server_id(<table>)
17316 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17317 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17318 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17319 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17320 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17321 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17322
17323table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017326 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017327 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17328 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17329 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17330 keyword.
17331
17332table_sess_rate(<table>)
17333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17336 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17337 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17338 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17339 keyword.
17340
17341table_trackers(<table>)
17342 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17343 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17344 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17345 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17346 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17347 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17348 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17349 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17350 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17351 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17352
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017353ub64dec
17354 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17355 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17356 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17357
17358 Example:
17359 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17360 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17361
17362ub64enc
17363 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17364
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017365upper
17366 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17367 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17368 type. The result is of type string.
17369
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017370url_dec([<in_form>])
17371 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17372 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17373 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17374 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17375 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17376 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017377
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017378url_enc([<enc_type>])
17379 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17380 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17381 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17382 optional argument is here for future changes.
17383
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017384ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017385 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017386 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17387 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17388 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017389 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17390 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17391 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17392 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017393 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017394 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17395 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017396
17397 Example:
17398 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17399 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17400
17401 message Point {
17402 int32 latitude = 1;
17403 int32 longitude = 2;
17404 }
17405
17406 message PPoint {
17407 Point point = 59;
17408 }
17409
17410 message Rectangle {
17411 // One corner of the rectangle.
17412 PPoint lo = 48;
17413 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17414 PPoint hi = 49;
17415 }
17416
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017417 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17418 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17419 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017420
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017421 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17422 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017423 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017424 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17425
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017426 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017427
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017428 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017429
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017430 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17431 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17432 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017433
17434 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17435 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17436 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17437
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017438 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17439 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17440 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017441
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017442
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017443unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017444 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17445 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17446 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17447 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17448 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17449 response),
17450 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17451 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17452 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17453 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17454
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017455utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17456 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17457 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17458 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17459 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17460 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17461 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17462
17463 Example :
17464
17465 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017466 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017467 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17468
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017469word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17470 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17471 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17472 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017473 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017474 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17475 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17476
17477 Example :
17478 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17479 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17480 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17481 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17482 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017483 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017484
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017485wt6([<avalanche>])
17486 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17487 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17488 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17489 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17490 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17491 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17492 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017493 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17494 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017495
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017496xor(<value>)
17497 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017498 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017499 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017500 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017504 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17506 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017507 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017508 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017509
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017510xxh3([<seed>])
17511 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17512 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17513 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17514 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17515 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17516 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17517 considered as cryptographically secure.
17518
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017519xxh32([<seed>])
17520 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17521 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17522 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17523 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17524 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17525 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17526 as cryptographically secure.
17527
17528xxh64([<seed>])
17529 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17530 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17531 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17532 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17533 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17534 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17535 as cryptographically secure.
17536
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175387.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017539--------------------------------------------
17540
17541A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17542not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17543"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17544The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17545
17546always_false : boolean
17547 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17548 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17549
17550always_true : boolean
17551 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17552 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17553
17554avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017555 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17557 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17558 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17559 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17560 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17561 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17562 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17563 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17564 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17565 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17566 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17567 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17568 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017571 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17572 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17573 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17574 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017575 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17576
17577be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17578 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17579 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17580 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17581 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17582 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017583 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17584 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017585
17586 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17587 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17588 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17592 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17593 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017594 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017595 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17596 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017597
17598 Example :
17599 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17600 backend dynamic
17601 mode http
17602 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17603 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017605bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017606 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17607 of the string.
17608
17609bool(<bool>) : bool
17610 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17611 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17614 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017615 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17617 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017618
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017619 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017620 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017621 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17622
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017623 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17624 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017625
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017626 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017627 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017629 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017630 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017632 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017633
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017634 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17635 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017636 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017637 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017638
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017639cpu_calls : integer
17640 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17641 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17642 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17643 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17644 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17645 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17646
17647cpu_ns_avg : integer
17648 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17649 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17650 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17651 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17652 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17653 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17654 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17655 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17656 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17657 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17658 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17659
17660cpu_ns_tot : integer
17661 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17662 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17663 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17664 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17665 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17666 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17667 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17668 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17669 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17670 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17671 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17672 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17673 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17674
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017675date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017676 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017677
17678 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17679 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17680 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017681 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17682
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017683 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17684 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17685 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17686 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17687 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17688
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017689 Example :
17690
17691 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17692 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017693
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017694 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17695 # millisecond granularity
17696 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17697
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017698date_us : integer
17699 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17700 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17701 from the same timeval structure.
17702
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017703distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17704 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17705 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17706 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17707 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017708 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017709 list of supported tokens.
17710
17711distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17712 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17713 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17714 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17715 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017716 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017717 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17718 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17719 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17720 supported tokens.
17721
17722 Example :
17723 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17724 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17725 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17726 # send large files to the big farm
17727 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17728
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017729env(<name>) : string
17730 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17731 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17732 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17733 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17734 certain way.
17735
17736 Examples :
17737 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17738 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17739
17740 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17741 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17744 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017745 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17746 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17748 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017749 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017750 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17751 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017752
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017753fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17754 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17755 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17756 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17759 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17760 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17761 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17762 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17763 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17764 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17765 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17766 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017767
17768 Example :
17769 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17770 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17771 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17772 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17773 frontend mail
17774 bind :25
17775 mode tcp
17776 maxconn 100
17777 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17778 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17779 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17780 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017781
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017782hostname : string
17783 Returns the system hostname.
17784
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017785int(<integer>) : signed integer
17786 Returns a signed integer.
17787
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017788ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17789 Returns an ipv4.
17790
17791ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17792 Returns an ipv6.
17793
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017794lat_ns_avg : integer
17795 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17796 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17797 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17798 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17799 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17800 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17801 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17802 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17803 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017804 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17805 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17806 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17807 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17808 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17809 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017810
17811lat_ns_tot : integer
17812 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17813 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17814 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17815 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17816 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17817 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17818 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17819 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17820 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017821 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17822 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17823 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17824 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17825 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017826 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17827 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17828 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17829 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17830 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17831 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17832
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017833meth(<method>) : method
17834 Returns a method.
17835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17837 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17838 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17839 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017840 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17841 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17842 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017843
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017844prio_class : integer
17845 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17846 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17847 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17848
17849prio_offset : integer
17850 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17851 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17852 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17853 set-priority-offset".
17854
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017855proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017856 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17857 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017860 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17861 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17862 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017863 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17864 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17865 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17866 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17867 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17868
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017869rand([<range>]) : integer
17870 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17871 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17872 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17873 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17874 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017876srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17877 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17878 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17879 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17880 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17881 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017882 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17883 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17884
17885srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17886 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17887 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17888 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17889 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17890 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17891 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17892 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17893
17894 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17895 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017896
17897srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17898 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17899 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17900 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017901 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17903 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17904 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17905
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017906srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17908 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17909 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17910 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17911 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17912 fetch methods.
17913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17915 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17916 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017917 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017918 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17919 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017920 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017921 overloading servers).
17922
17923 Example :
17924 # Redirect to a separate back
17925 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17926 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17927 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17928
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017929srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017930 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17931 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17932 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17933
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017934srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017935 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17936 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17937 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17938
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017939srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017940 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17941 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17942 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17943
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017944stopping : boolean
17945 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17946 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17947 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17948
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017949str(<string>) : string
17950 Returns a string.
17951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17953 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17954 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17955
17956table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17957 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17958 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17959 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17960
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017961thread : integer
17962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17963 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17964 and debugging purposes.
17965
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017966uuid([<version>]) : string
17967 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17968 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17969 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17970
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020017971var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017972 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020017973 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
17974 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
17975 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017976 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017977 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17978 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017979 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017980 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17981 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017982 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017983 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017986----------------------------------
17987
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017988The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17990methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17991sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17992TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017993the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17994counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017995"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17996used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17997can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17998Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17999table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18000tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18001currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018002
Remi Tricot-Le Breton942c1672021-09-01 15:52:15 +020018003bc_conn_err : integer
18004 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18005 connection. See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18006 and their corresponding error message.
18007
18008bc_conn_err_str : string
18009 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18010 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18011 "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18012 corresponding error message.
18013
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018014bc_dst : ip
18015 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18016 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18017 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18018 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18019
18020bc_dst_port : integer
18021 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018022 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018023
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018024bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018025 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18026 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18027 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18028
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018029bc_src : ip
18030 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018031 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018032 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18033 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18034
18035bc_src_port : integer
18036 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018037 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018039be_id : integer
18040 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018041 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18042 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018043
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018044be_name : string
18045 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018046 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18047 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018048
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018049be_server_timeout : integer
18050 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18051 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18052 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18053
18054be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18055 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18056 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18057 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18058
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018059cur_server_timeout : integer
18060 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18061 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18062 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18063
18064cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18065 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18066 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18067 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018069dst : ip
18070 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
18071 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
18072 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
18073 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018074 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
18075 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
18076 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
18077 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
18078 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
18079 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080
18081dst_conn : integer
18082 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18083 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18084 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18085 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18086 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18087 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18088 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18089 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018090
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018091dst_is_local : boolean
18092 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18093 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18094 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18095 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018096 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018097 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18098 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18099 it only once per connection.
18100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018101dst_port : integer
18102 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18103 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
18104 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
18105 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
18106 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
18107 an HTTP header.
18108
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018109fc_conn_err : integer
18110 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18111 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18112 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018113 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018114 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18115
18116fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018117 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018118 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
18119 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
18120 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18121
18122 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18123 | ID | message |
18124 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18125 | 0 | "Success" |
18126 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18127 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18128 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18129 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18130 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18131 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18132 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18133 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18134 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18135 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18136 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18137 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18138 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18139 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18140 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18141 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18142 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18143 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18144 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18145 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18146 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18147 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18148 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18149 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18150 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18151 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18152 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18153 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18154 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18155 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18156 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18157 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18158 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18159 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18160 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18161 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18162 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18163 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18164 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18165 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18166 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18167 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018168 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018169 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18170
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018171fc_http_major : integer
18172 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18173 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18174 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18175
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018176fc_pp_authority : string
18177 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18178 if any.
18179
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018180fc_pp_unique_id : string
18181 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18182 if any.
18183
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018184fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18185 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18186 header.
18187
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018188fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18189 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18190 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18191 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18192 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18193 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18194 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18195
18196fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18197 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18198 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18199 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18200 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18201 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18202 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18203
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018204fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018205 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18206 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18207 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18208 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18209
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018210fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018211 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18212 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18213 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18214 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18215
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018216fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018217 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18218 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18219 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18220 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18221
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018222fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018223 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18224 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18225 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18226 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18227
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018228fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018229 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18230 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18231 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18232 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18233
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018234fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018235 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18236 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18237 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18238 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18239
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018240fe_defbe : string
18241 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18242 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244fe_id : integer
18245 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018246 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018247 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18248
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018249fe_name : string
18250 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18251 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18252 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18253
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018254fe_client_timeout : integer
18255 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18256 current frontend.
18257
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018258sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018259sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18260sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18261sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018262 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18263 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18264 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18265
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018266sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018267sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18268sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18269sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018270 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18271 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18272 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18273
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018274sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18275 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18276 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18277 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18278 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18279 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18280 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18281 will always return zero.
18282 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18283 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18284
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018285sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018286sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18287sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18288sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018289 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18290 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018291 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18292 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18293 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018294
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018295 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018296 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18297 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018298 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18299 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18300 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018301 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18302 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18303
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018304sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18305sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18306sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18307sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18308 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18309 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18310 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18311 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18312 when a first ACL was verified.
18313
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018314sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018315sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18316sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18317sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018318 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018319 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18320
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018321sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018322sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18323sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18324sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018325 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18326 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18327 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18328
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018329sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018330sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18331sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18332sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018333 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18334 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18335 See also src_conn_rate.
18336
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018337sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18338 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18339 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18340 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18341 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18342 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18343 index, zero is returned.
18344 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18345 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18346
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018347sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018348sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18349sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18350sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018351 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018352 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018353
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018354sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18355sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18356sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18357sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18358 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18359 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18360
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018361sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18362 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18363 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18364 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18365 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18366 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18367 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18368 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18369
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018370sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18371sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18372sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18373sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18374 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18375 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18376
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018377sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18378 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18379 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18380 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18381 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18382 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18383 between 0 and 2.
18384 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18385 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18386 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18387 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18388 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18389
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018390sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018391sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18392sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18393sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018394 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18395 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18396 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018397 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18398 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18399 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018400
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018401sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18402sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18403sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18404sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18405 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18406 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18407 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18408 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18409 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18410 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018412sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018413sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18414sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18415sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018416 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018417 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18418 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18419
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018420sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018421sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18422sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18423sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018424 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18425 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18426 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18427 src_http_err_rate.
18428
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018429sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18430sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18431sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18432sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18433 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18434 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18435 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18436
18437sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18438sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18439sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18440sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18441 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18442 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18443 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18444 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18445
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018446sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018447sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18448sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18449sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018450 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018451 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18452 src_http_req_cnt.
18453
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018454sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018455sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18456sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18457sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018458 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18459 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18460 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18461 src_http_req_rate.
18462
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018463sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18464 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18465 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18466 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18467 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18468 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18469 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18470 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18471 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18472 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018474sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018475sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18476sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18477sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018478 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018479 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18480 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18481 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18482 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018483
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018484 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018485 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18486 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018487 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18488
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018489sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18490sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18491sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18492sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18493 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18494 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18495 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18496 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18497 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018499sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018500sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18501sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18502sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018503 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18504 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18505 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018507sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018508sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18509sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18510sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018511 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18512 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18513 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018515sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018516sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18517sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18518sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018519 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018520 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18521 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18522 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018523 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018524 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018526sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018527sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18528sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18529sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018530 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18531 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18532 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18533 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18534 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018535 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018537sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018538sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18539sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18540sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018541 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18542 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18543 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18544
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018545sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018546sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18547sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18548sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018549 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18550 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018551 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018552 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18553 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018554 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18555 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18556 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018558so_id : integer
18559 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18560 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18561 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018562
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018563so_name : string
18564 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18565 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18566 strings instead of integers.
18567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018568src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018569 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18571 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18572 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018573 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18574 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18575 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018576 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18577 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18578 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18579 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18580 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18581 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18582 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018583
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018584 Example:
18585 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18586 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018588src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18589 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18590 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18591 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018592 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018594src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18595 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18596 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018597 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018598 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018599
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018600src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18601 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18602 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18603 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18604 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18605 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18606 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18607 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18608 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018610src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18611 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18612 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18613 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18614 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18615 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18616 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018617
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018618 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018619 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18620 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18621 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18622 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018623 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018624 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18625 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18626
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018627src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18628 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18629 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18630 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18631 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18632 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18633 was verified.
18634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018636 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018637 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018638 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018639 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018641src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018642 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018643 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18644 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018645 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18648 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18649 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18650 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018651 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018652
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018653src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18654 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18655 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18656 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18657 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18658 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18659 is returned.
18660 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18661 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18662 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018664src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018665 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018666 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018667 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018668 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018669
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018670src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18671 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18672 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18673 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18674 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18675
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018676src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18677 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18678 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18679 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18680 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18681 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18682 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18683
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018684src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18685 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18686 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18687 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18688 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18689
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018690src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18691 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18692 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18693 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18694 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18695 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18696 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18697 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18698 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18699 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18700 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018703 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018704 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018705 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18706 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018707 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18708 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18709 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018710
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018711src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18712 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18713 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18714 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18715 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18716 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18717 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18718 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018720src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018721 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018722 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018723 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018724 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018725 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018727src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18728 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18729 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18730 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18731 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018732 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018733
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018734src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18735 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18736 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018737 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018738 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18739 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18740
18741src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18742 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18743 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18744 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18745 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18746 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18747 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018749src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018750 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18752 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018753 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018755src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18756 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18757 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18758 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018759 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018760 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018761
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018762src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18763 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18764 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18765 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18766 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18767 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18768 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18769 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18770 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18773 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18774 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18775 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018776 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18778 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018779
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018780 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018781 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018782 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018783 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018784
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018785src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18786 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18787 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18788 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18789 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18790 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18791 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18792
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018793src_is_local : boolean
18794 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18795 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18796 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18797 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018798 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018799 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18800 once per connection.
18801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018803 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18804 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18805 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18806 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18807 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018809src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018810 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18811 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18812 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18813 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18814 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018816src_port : integer
18817 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18818 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18819 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18820 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018823 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018824 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18825 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18826 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018827 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18830 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18831 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18832 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18833 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018834 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18837 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18838 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18839 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18840 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18841 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18842 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18843 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18844 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018845
18846 Example :
18847 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18848 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18849 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18850 listen ssh
18851 bind :22
18852 mode tcp
18853 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018854 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018856 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858srv_id : integer
18859 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18860 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018861 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018862
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018863srv_name : string
18864 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18865 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018866 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018867
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188687.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018870
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018871The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18873when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18874usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018875future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018876
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001887751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18878 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18879 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18880 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18881 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18882 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18883
18884 Example :
18885 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18886 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18887 # the request.
18888 frontend http-in
18889 bind *:8081
18890 default_backend servers
18891 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18892 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18893
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018894ssl_bc : boolean
18895 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18896 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018897 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18898 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018899
18900ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18901 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018902 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18903 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018904
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018905ssl_bc_alpn : string
18906 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18907 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018908 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018909 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18910 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18911 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18912 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18913 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018914 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18915 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018916
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018917ssl_bc_cipher : string
18918 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018919 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18920 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018921
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018922ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18923 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18924 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18925 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018926 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018927
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018928ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018929 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018930 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
18931 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
18932 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
18933 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018934 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
18935 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
18936 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18937
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018938ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018939 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018940 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
18941 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
18942 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018943
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018944ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18945 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18946 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018947 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18948 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018949
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018950ssl_bc_npn : string
18951 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18952 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018953 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018954 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18955 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18956 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18957 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018958 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18959 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018960
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018961ssl_bc_protocol : string
18962 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018963 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18964 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018965
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018966ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018967 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018968 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018969 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18970 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018971
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018972ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18973 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18974 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18975 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018976 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018977
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018978ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18979 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18980 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018981 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18982 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018983
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018984ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18985 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18986 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18987 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018988 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018989
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018990ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18991 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018992 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18993 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018995ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18996 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18997 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18998 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18999 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19000 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019002ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19004 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19005 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19006 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019007
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019008ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019009 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19010 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19011 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019012 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019013 does not support resumed sessions.
19014
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019015ssl_c_der : binary
19016 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19017 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19018 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019020ssl_c_err : integer
19021 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19022 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19023 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19024 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19025 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019026
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019027ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019028 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19029 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19030 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19031 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19032 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19033 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19034 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19035 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019036 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19037 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19038 LDAP v3.
19039 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19040 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042ssl_c_key_alg : string
19043 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19044 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19045 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047ssl_c_notafter : string
19048 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19049 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19050 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019052ssl_c_notbefore : string
19053 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19054 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19055 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019056
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019057ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019058 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19059 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19060 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19061 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19062 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19063 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19064 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19065 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019066 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19067 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19068 LDAP v3.
19069 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19070 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072ssl_c_serial : binary
19073 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19074 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19075 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019077ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19078 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19079 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19080 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019081 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19082 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19083
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019084 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019085 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019087ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19088 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19089 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19090 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092ssl_c_used : boolean
19093 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19094 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019096ssl_c_verify : integer
19097 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19098 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19099 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19100 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102ssl_c_version : integer
19103 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19104 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019105
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019106ssl_f_der : binary
19107 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19108 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19109 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19110
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019111ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019112 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19113 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19114 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19115 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019116 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019117 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19118 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19119 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019120 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19121 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19122 LDAP v3.
19123 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19124 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019126ssl_f_key_alg : string
19127 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19128 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19129 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131ssl_f_notafter : string
19132 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19133 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19134 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136ssl_f_notbefore : string
19137 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19138 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19139 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019140
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019141ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019142 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19143 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19144 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19145 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19146 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19147 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19148 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19149 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019150 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19151 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19152 LDAP v3.
19153 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19154 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156ssl_f_serial : binary
19157 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19158 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19159 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019160
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019161ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19162 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19163 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19164 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019166ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19167 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19168 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19169 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019171ssl_f_version : integer
19172 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19173 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19174
19175ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019176 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19177 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19178 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180 Example :
19181 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19182 listen http-https
19183 bind :80
19184 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19185 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19186
19187ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19188 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19189 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19190
19191ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019192 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019193 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019194 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019195 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19196 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19197 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19198 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19199 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19200 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202ssl_fc_cipher : string
19203 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19204 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019205
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019206ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19207 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19208 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019209 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019210 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19211 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19212 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019213
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019214 Example:
19215 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19216 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19217 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19218 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19219 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19220 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19221 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19222 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19223 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19224
19225ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019226 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019227 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019228 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19229 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019230 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19231 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019232
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019233ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019234 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019235 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019236 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019237 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19238 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19239 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19240 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19241 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19242 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019243
19244ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019245 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019246 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19247 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019248
19249ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19250 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19251 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019252 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019253
19254 Example:
19255 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19256 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19257 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19258 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19259 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19260 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19261 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19262 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19263 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19264
19265ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19266 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19267 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019268 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019269 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19270 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19271 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19272
19273 Example:
19274 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19275 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19276 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19277 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19278 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19279 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19280 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19281 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19282 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19283
19284ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19285 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19286 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019287 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019288 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19289 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19290 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19291
19292 Example:
19293 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19294 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19295 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19296 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19297 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19298 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19299 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19300 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19301 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019302
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019303ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19304 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19305 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19306 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19307
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019308ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19309 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19310 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19311 transport layer.
19312 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19313 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19314 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19315 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19316
19317ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19318 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19319 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19320 transport layer.
19321 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19322 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19323 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19324 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19325
19326ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19327 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19328 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19329 transport layer.
19330 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19331 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19332 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19333 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19334
19335ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19336 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19337 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19338 transport layer.
19339 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19340 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19341 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19342 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19343
19344ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19345 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19346 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19347 transport layer.
19348 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19349 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19350 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19351 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19352
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019353ssl_fc_err : integer
19354 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19355 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19356 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19357 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19358 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19359 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19360 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19361 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19362 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19363 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19364 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19365 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19366 codes.
19367
19368ssl_fc_err_str : string
19369 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19370 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19371 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19372 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19373 also "ssl_fc_err".
19374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019375ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019376 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19377 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019378 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19379 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19380 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19381 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019382
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019383ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19384 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19385 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19386 wait until the handshake happened.
19387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019388ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19389 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019390 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19391 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019392 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019393 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019394
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019395ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019396 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019397 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19398 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019400ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019401 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019402 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019403 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19404 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19405 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19406 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19407 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19408 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410ssl_fc_protocol : string
19411 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19412 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019413
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019414ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19415 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19416 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019417 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19418 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019419
19420 Example:
19421 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19422 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19423 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19424 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19425 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19426 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19427 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19428 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19429 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19430
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019431ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019432 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019433 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19434 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019435
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019436ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19437 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19438 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19439 transport layer.
19440 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19441 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19442 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19443 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19444
19445ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19446 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19447 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19448 transport layer.
19449 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19450 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19451 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19452 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19453
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019454ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19455 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19456 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19457 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019459ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19460 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19461 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19462 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19463 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019464
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019465ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19466 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19467 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19468 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19469 BoringSSL.
19470
19471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019472ssl_fc_sni : string
19473 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19474 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019475 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019476 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19477 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19478
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019479 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019480 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019482 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019483 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19487 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19490 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19491 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019492
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019493ssl_s_der : binary
19494 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19495 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19496 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19497
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019498ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19499 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19500 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19501 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019502 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019503 does not support resumed sessions.
19504
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019505ssl_s_key_alg : string
19506 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19507 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19508 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19509
19510ssl_s_notafter : string
19511 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19512 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19513 transport layer.
19514
19515ssl_s_notbefore : string
19516 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19517 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19518 transport layer.
19519
19520ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19521 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19522 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19523 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19524 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19525 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19526 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019527 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19528 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019529 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19530 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19531 LDAP v3.
19532 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19533 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19534
19535ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19536 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19537 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19538 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19539 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19540 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19541 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019542 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19543 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019544 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19545 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19546 LDAP v3.
19547 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19548 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19549
19550ssl_s_serial : binary
19551 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19552 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19553 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19554
19555ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19556 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19557 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19558 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19559
19560ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19561 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19562 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19563 layer.
19564
19565ssl_s_version : integer
19566 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19567 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019568
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195697.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019572Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19573sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19574only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19575For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19576be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19577can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19578sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19579for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19580content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019581
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019582Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19583 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019584 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019585 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19586 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19587 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19588 sample expression). So be careful.
19589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019590payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019591 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019592 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19593 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019595payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19596 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019597 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019598 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019600req.len : integer
19601req_len : integer (deprecated)
19602 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19603 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19604 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19605 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19606 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019607 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19609 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019611req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19612 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019613 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19614 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19615 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19616 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618 ACL alternatives :
19619 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019621req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19622 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19623 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19624 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19625 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019627 ACL alternatives :
19628 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019632req.proto_http : boolean
19633req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19634 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19635 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19636 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19637 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19638 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19639 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19640 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019642 Example:
19643 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19644 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19645 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019646 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019648req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19649rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19650 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19651 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19652 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19653 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19654 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19655 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19656 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019658 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19659 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19660 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19661 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19662 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19663 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019665 ACL derivatives :
19666 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668 Example :
19669 listen tse-farm
19670 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19671 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19672 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19673 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19674 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19675 persist rdp-cookie
19676 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19677 # This is only useful makes sense if
19678 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19679 stick-table type string size 204800
19680 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19681 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19682 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019684 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19685 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019687req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19688rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19689 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19690 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19691 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19692 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694 ACL derivatives :
19695 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019696
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019697req.ssl_alpn : string
19698 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19699 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19700 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19701 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19702 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19703 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019704 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019705
19706 Examples :
19707 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19708 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19709 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019710 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019711 default_backend bk_default
19712
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019713req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19714 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19715 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019716 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19717 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19718 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19719 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19720 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019722req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19723req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19724 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19725 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19726 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19727 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19728 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19729 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19730 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019732req.ssl_sni : string
19733req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19734 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19735 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19736 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19737 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19738 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019739 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19740 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19741 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19742 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19743 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19744 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19745 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19746 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19747 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019749 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019750 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019752 Examples :
19753 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19754 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19755 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019756 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019757 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019758
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019759req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19760 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19761 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19762 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19763 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19764 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19765 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19766 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19767 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19768 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019770req.ssl_ver : integer
19771req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19772 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19773 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19774 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19775 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19776 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19777 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19778 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019779 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019780 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019782 ACL derivatives :
19783 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019784
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019785res.len : integer
19786 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19787 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19788 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19789 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19790 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019791 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019792 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019793 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019795res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19796 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019797 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019798 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019799 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019800 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019802res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19803 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19804 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19805 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019806 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19807 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019810
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019811res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19812rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19813 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19814 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19815 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19816 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19817 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19818 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19819 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019821wait_end : boolean
19822 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19823 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019824 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019825 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19826 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019827 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019828 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19829 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019831 Examples :
19832 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19833 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19834 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019836 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19837 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19838 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19839 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19840 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19841 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19842 tcp-request content reject
19843
19844
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200198457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846--------------------------------------
19847
19848It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19849This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19850data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19851its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19852HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19853content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19854to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19855more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19856response are indexed.
19857
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019858Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19859 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19860 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19861 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19862 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19863 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19864 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866base : string
19867 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19868 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19869 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19870 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19871 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19872 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19873 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19874 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19875
19876 ACL derivatives :
19877 base : exact string match
19878 base_beg : prefix match
19879 base_dir : subdir match
19880 base_dom : domain match
19881 base_end : suffix match
19882 base_len : length match
19883 base_reg : regex match
19884 base_sub : substring match
19885
19886base32 : integer
19887 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19888 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19889 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019890 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19891 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19892 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893
19894base32+src : binary
19895 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19896 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19897 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19898 per-URL counters.
19899
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019900baseq : string
19901 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19902 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19903 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19904 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19905
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019906capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19907 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19908 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19909 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19910
19911capture.req.method : string
19912 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19913 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19914 because it's allocated.
19915
19916capture.req.uri : string
19917 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19918 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19919 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19920 allocated.
19921
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019922capture.req.ver : string
19923 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19924 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19925 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19926
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019927capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19928 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19929 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19930 The first entry is an index of 0.
19931 See also: "capture response header"
19932
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019933capture.res.ver : string
19934 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19935 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19936 persistent flag.
19937
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019938req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019939 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19940 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19941 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019942
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019943req.body_param([<name>) : string
19944 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19945 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19946 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19947 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19948 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19949 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19950 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19951 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19952 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19953 given.
19954
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019955req.body_len : integer
19956 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19957 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019958 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19959 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019960
19961req.body_size : integer
19962 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019963 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19964 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019966req.cook([<name>]) : string
19967cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19968 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19969 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19970 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19971 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19972 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19973 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19974 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19975 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19976
19977 ACL derivatives :
19978 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19979 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19980 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19981 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19982 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19983 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19984 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19985 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019987req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19988cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19990 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019992req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19993cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19994 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19995 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19996 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19997 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019999cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20000 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20001 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20002 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20003 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020004 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20006 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20007 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20008 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020010hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20011 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20012 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20013 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20014 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020015 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020017req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020018 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20019 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20020 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20021 with headers such as User-Agent.
20022
20023 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20024 found.
20025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020026 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20027 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20028 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020029 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020031req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20032 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20033 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020034 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20035 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020037req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020038 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20039 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20040 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20041 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20042 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20043 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20044 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20045
20046 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20047 found.
20048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020049 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20050 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20051 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020052 with -1 being the last one.
20053
20054 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20055 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020057 ACL derivatives :
20058 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20059 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20060 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20061 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20062 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20063 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20064 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20065 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20066
20067req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20068hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20069 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20070 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020071 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20072 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20073 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20074
20075 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20076 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20077 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20078
20079 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020080
20081req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20082hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20083 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20084 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20085 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020086 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20087 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20088 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20089 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20090 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020091
20092 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20093
20094 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020095
20096req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20097hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20098 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20099 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20100 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020101
20102 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20103
20104 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020105
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020106req.hdrs : string
20107 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20108 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20109 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20110 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20111
20112req.hdrs_bin : binary
20113 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20114 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20115 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20116 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20117 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20118 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20119
20120 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020121
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020122 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20123 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020125http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20126 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20127 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20128 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20129 basic auth is supported.
20130
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020131http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20132 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20133 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20134 performed on the data sent by the client.
20135 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20136 Authorization one.
20137
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020138http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20139 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20140 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20141 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20142 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020143 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20144 basic auth is supported.
20145
20146 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020147 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20148 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20149 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20150 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020151
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020152http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020153 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20154 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20155 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020156
20157http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020158 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20159 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20160 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020161
20162http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020163 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20164 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20165 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020167http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020168 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20169 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020170 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20171 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020173method : integer + string
20174 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20175 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20176 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20177 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20178 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20179 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20180 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020182 ACL derivatives :
20183 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020185 Example :
20186 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20187 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20188 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020190path : string
20191 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20192 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20193 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20194 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20195 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020196 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020197 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020199 ACL derivatives :
20200 path : exact string match
20201 path_beg : prefix match
20202 path_dir : subdir match
20203 path_dom : domain match
20204 path_end : suffix match
20205 path_len : length match
20206 path_reg : regex match
20207 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020208
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020209pathq : string
20210 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20211 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20212 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20213 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20214 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20215 result in both cases.
20216
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020217query : string
20218 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20219 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20220 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20221 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020222 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020223 which stops before the question mark.
20224
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020225req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20226 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20227 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20228 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20229 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020231req.ver : string
20232req_ver : string (deprecated)
20233 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20234 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20235 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020237 ACL derivatives :
20238 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020239
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020240res.body : binary
20241 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20242 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020243 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20244
20245 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020246
20247res.body_len : integer
20248 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20249 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020250 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20251
20252 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020253
20254res.body_size : integer
20255 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20256 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20257 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20258 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020259 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20260
20261 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020262
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020263res.cache_hit : boolean
20264 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20265 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20266
20267res.cache_name : string
20268 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20269 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20270 empty string.
20271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020272res.comp : boolean
20273 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20274 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20275 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020277res.comp_algo : string
20278 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20279 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20280 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020282res.cook([<name>]) : string
20283scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20284 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20285 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020286 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20287
20288 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020290 ACL derivatives :
20291 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020293res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20294scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20295 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20296 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020297 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20298
20299 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020301res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20302scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20303 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20304 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020305 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20306
20307 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020309res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020310 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20311 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20312
20313 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20314 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20315
20316 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20317
20318 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020320res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020321 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20322 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20323
20324 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20325 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20326
20327 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020329res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20330shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020331 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20332 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20333
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020334 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020335 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20336
20337 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020339 ACL derivatives :
20340 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20341 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20342 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20343 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20344 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20345 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20346 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20347 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20348
20349res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20350shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020351 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20352 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20353
20354 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020355 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020356
20357 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020359res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20360shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020361 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20362 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20363
20364 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20365
20366 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020367
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020368res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20369 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20370 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20371 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020372 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20373
20374 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020376res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20377shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020378 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20379 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20380
20381 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20382
20383 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020384
20385res.hdrs : string
20386 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20387 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20388 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020389 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20390
20391 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020392
20393res.hdrs_bin : binary
20394 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20395 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20396 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20397 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20398 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20399 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20400 (length of 0 for both).
20401
20402 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20403
20404 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20405 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020407res.ver : string
20408resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20409 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020410 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20411
20412 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020414 ACL derivatives :
20415 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020417set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20418 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20419 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020420 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020421 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020423 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20424 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020426status : integer
20427 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20428 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020429 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20430
20431 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020432
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020433unique-id : string
20434 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20435 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20436 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20437 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20438 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20439 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020441url : string
20442 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20443 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20444 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20445 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20446 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20447 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20448 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020450 ACL derivatives :
20451 url : exact string match
20452 url_beg : prefix match
20453 url_dir : subdir match
20454 url_dom : domain match
20455 url_end : suffix match
20456 url_len : length match
20457 url_reg : regex match
20458 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020460url_ip : ip
20461 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20462 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20463 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20464 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020465 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20466 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020468url_port : integer
20469 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020470 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020471
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020472urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20473url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020474 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20475 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020476 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20477 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20478 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20479 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020480 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20481 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020482 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20483 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020485 ACL derivatives :
20486 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20487 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20488 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20489 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20490 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20491 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20492 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20493 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020494
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020496 Example :
20497 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20498 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20499 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20500 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020501
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020502urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020503 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20504 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20505 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020506
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020507url32 : integer
20508 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20509 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20510 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20511 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20512 is an unsigned integer.
20513
20514url32+src : binary
20515 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20516 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20517 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20518
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020519
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200205207.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020521---------------------------------------
20522
20523This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20524used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20525purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20526There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20527or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20528any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20529for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20530
20531internal.htx.data : integer
20532 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20533 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20534
20535internal.htx.free : integer
20536 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20537 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20538
20539internal.htx.free_data : integer
20540 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20541 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20542
20543internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020544 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20545 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20546 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020547
20548internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20549 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20550 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20551
20552internal.htx.size : integer
20553 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20554 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20555
20556internal.htx.used : integer
20557 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20558 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20559 direction.
20560
20561internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20562 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20563 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20564 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20565 of the special value :
20566 * head : The oldest inserted block
20567 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020568 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020569
20570internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20571 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20572 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20573 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20574 integer or one of the special value :
20575 * head : The oldest inserted block
20576 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020577 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020578
20579internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20580 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20581 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20582 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20583 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20584
20585 * head : The oldest inserted block
20586 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020587 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020588
20589internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20590 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20591 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20592 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20593 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20594
20595 * head : The oldest inserted block
20596 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020597 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020598
20599internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20600 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20601 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20602 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20603 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20604
20605 * head : The oldest inserted block
20606 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020607 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020608
20609internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20610 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20611 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20612 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20613 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20614
20615 * head : The oldest inserted block
20616 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020617 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020618
20619internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20620 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20621 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20622 it returns false.
20623
20624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200206257.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020626---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020628Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20629every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020630order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020632ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020633---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20634FALSE always_false never match
20635HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20636HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20637HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020638HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020639HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20640HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20641HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20642HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20643LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20644METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20645METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20646METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20647METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20648METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20649METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20650METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20651METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20652RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20653REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20654TRUE always_true always match
20655WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20656---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020657
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206598. Logging
20660----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020661
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020662One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20663provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20664very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20665provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20666state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020667to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020668headers.
20669
20670In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20671about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20672send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20673
20674 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20675 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20676 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20677 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20678 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020679 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020680 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020681
20682The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20683allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20684as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20685while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20686real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20687delay.
20688
20689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206908.1. Log levels
20691---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020692
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020693TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020694source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020695HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20696in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20697track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20698syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20699about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020700
20701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207028.2. Log formats
20703----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020704
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020705HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020706and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20707slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20708options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020709
20710 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20711 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20712 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20713 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20714 extents.
20715
20716 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20717 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20718 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20719 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20720 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20721
20722 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20723 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20724 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20725 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20726 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20727
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020728 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20729 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20730 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20731 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020733 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20734
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020735Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20736specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20737field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20738servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20739always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20740identifier.
20741
20742Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20743 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20744 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20745 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20746 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20747
20748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207498.2.1. Default log format
20750-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020751
20752This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20753as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20754format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20755
20756 Example :
20757 listen www
20758 mode http
20759 log global
20760 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20761
20762 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20763 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20764 (www/HTTP)
20765
20766 Field Format Extract from the example above
20767 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20768 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20769 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20770 4 'to' to
20771 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20772 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20773
20774Detailed fields description :
20775 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20776 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20777 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20778 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20779 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20780 and processed the connection.
20781 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20782
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020783In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20784"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20785connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20786
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020787It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20788will eventually disappear.
20789
20790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207918.2.2. TCP log format
20792---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020793
20794The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20795is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20796information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20797counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20798emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20799environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20800the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20801sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020802specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20803not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20804fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20805marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020806
20807 Example :
20808 frontend fnt
20809 mode tcp
20810 option tcplog
20811 log global
20812 default_backend bck
20813
20814 backend bck
20815 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20816
20817 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20818 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20819 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20820
20821 Field Format Extract from the example above
20822 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20823 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20824 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20825 4 frontend_name fnt
20826 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20827 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20828 7 bytes_read* 212
20829 8 termination_state --
20830 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20831 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20832
20833Detailed fields description :
20834 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020835 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020836 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20837 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020838 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020839 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020840 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020841
20842 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020843 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20844 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20845 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020846
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020847 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020848 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20849 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020850 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20851 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20852 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20853 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020854
20855 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20856 and processed the connection.
20857
20858 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20859 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20860 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20861 applications.
20862
20863 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20864 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20865 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20866 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20867 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20868
20869 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20870 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20871 See "Timers" below for more details.
20872
20873 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20874 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20875 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20876 "Timers" below for more details.
20877
20878 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020879 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020880 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20881 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20882 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20883 details.
20884
20885 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20886 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20887 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20888 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20889 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20890
20891 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20892 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20893 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20894 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20895 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20896 for more details.
20897
20898 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020899 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020900 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20901 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20902 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020903 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020904
20905 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20906 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20907 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20908 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20909 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20910 caused by a denial of service attack.
20911
20912 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20913 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20914 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20915 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20916 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20917 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20918 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20919 denial of service attack.
20920
20921 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20922 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20923 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20924 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20925 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20926 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20927 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20928 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20929 be processed than on other servers.
20930
20931 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20932 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20933 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20934 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020935 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020936 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20937 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20938 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20939 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20940 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20941 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20942 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20943 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20944
20945 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20946 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20947 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20948 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20949 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20950 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020951 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020952 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20953
20954 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20955 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20956 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20957 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20958 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20959 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020960 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020961 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20962 occurs.
20963
20964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209658.2.3. HTTP log format
20966----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020967
20968The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20969is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20970the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20971are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20972emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20973generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20974"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20975which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020976frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20977is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020978
20979Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20980slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20981with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20982
20983 Example :
20984 frontend http-in
20985 mode http
20986 option httplog
20987 log global
20988 default_backend bck
20989
20990 backend static
20991 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20992
20993 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20994 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20995 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020996 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020997
20998 Field Format Extract from the example above
20999 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21000 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021001 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021002 4 frontend_name http-in
21003 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021004 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021005 7 status_code 200
21006 8 bytes_read* 2750
21007 9 captured_request_cookie -
21008 10 captured_response_cookie -
21009 11 termination_state ----
21010 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21011 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21012 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21013 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21014 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021015
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021016Detailed fields description :
21017 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021018 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021019 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21020 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021021 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021022 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021023 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021024
21025 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021026 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21027 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21028 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021029
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021030 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021031 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021032
21033 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21034 and processed the connection.
21035
21036 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21037 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21038 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21039
21040 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21041 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21042 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21043 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21044 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21045 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021047 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21048 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21049 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021050 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021051 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21052 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021053 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021054 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055
21056 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21057 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021058 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021059
21060 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21061 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021062 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21063 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021064
21065 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21066 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21067 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21068 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21069 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021070 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21071 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021072
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021073 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021074 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21075 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21076 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21077 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21078 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21079 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021080 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021081
21082 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021083 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21084 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021085
21086 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21087 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021088 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021089 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21090 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21091 overflowing.
21092
21093 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21094 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21095 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21096 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21097 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21098 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21099 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21100 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21101
21102 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21103 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21104 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21105 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21106 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21107 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21108 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21109 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21110
21111 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21112 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21113 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21114 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21115 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21116 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21117 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21118
21119 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021120 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021121 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21122 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21123 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021124 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021125 system.
21126
21127 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21128 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21129 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21130 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21131 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21132 caused by a denial of service attack.
21133
21134 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21135 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21136 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21137 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21138 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21139 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21140 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21141 denial of service attack.
21142
21143 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21144 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21145 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21146 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21147 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21148 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21149 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21150 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21151 processed than on other servers.
21152
21153 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21154 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21155 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21156 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021157 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021158 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21159 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21160 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21161 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21162 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21163 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21164 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21165 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21166
21167 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21168 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21169 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21170 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21171 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21172 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021173 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021174 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21175
21176 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21177 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21178 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21179 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21180 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21181 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021182 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021183 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21184 occurs.
21185
21186 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21187 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21188 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21189 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21190 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21191 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21192 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21193 cookies" below for more details.
21194
21195 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21196 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21197 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21198 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21199 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21200 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21201 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21202 and cookies" below for more details.
21203
21204 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21205 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21206 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21207 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21208 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21209 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21210 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21211 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21212
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021213
212148.2.4. HTTPS log format
21215----------------------
21216
21217The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21218extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21219information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21220frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21221end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21222matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21223sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21224dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21225"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21226
21227This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21228appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21229HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021230
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021231 Example :
21232 frontend https-in
21233 mode http
21234 option httpslog
21235 log global
21236 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21237 default_backend bck
21238
21239 backend static
21240 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21241
21242 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21243 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21244 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021245 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021246
21247 Field Format Extract from the example above
21248 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21249 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21250 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21251 4 frontend_name https-in
21252 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21253 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21254 7 status_code 200
21255 8 bytes_read* 2750
21256 9 captured_request_cookie -
21257 10 captured_response_cookie -
21258 11 termination_state ----
21259 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21260 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21261 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21262 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21263 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021264 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
21265 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021266 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
21267
21268Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020021269 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021270 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
21271 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
21272
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021273 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21274 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21275 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
21276 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's decription for more
21277 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021278
21279 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21280 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21281 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21282 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21283
21284 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21285 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21286 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21287 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21288
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021289 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21290 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21291 can be shared by multiple requests.
21292
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021293 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21294
21295 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21296
21297
212988.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021299------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021300
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021301The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021302mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021303
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021304HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021305Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21306separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21307prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21308
21309Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21310variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021311("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021312
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021313If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021314as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021315less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21316the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21317
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021318Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21319"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21320delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21321preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021322
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021323Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21324'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21325https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21326such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21327
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021328Flags are :
21329 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021330 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021331 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21332 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021333
21334 Example:
21335
21336 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21337 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21338
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021339 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21340
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021341At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21342
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021343 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21344 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021345
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021346the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021347
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021348 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21349 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21350 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021351
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021352the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21353
21354 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21355 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021356 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
21357 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %sslv/%sslc"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021358
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021359and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21360
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021361 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21362 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021363
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021364Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21365
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021366 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021367 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021368 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21369 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21370 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021371 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21372 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21373 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021374 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021375 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021376 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021377 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021378 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021379 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21380 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021381 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021382 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021383 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021384 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021385 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021386 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021387 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021388 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21389 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21390 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21391 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21392 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021393 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021394 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021395 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021396 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021397 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021398 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21399 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021400 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21401 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21402 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021403 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021404 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21405 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021406 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021407 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21408 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21409 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021410 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021411 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021412 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21413 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21414 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21415 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021416 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021417 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021418 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021419 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021420 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021421 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021422 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21423 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21424 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021425 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021426 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21427 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021428 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021429 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21430 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021431 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021432 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021433 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021434 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021435
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021436 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021437
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021438
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200214398.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021440-----------------------
21441
21442When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021443protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21444unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21445line. In the latter case, the legacy log format described below will not be
21446used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the defined format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021447By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21448"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021449will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021450logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021451
21452The format looks like this :
21453
21454 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21455 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21456 Connection error during SSL handshake
21457
21458 Field Format Extract from the example above
21459 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21460 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21461 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21462 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21463 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21464
21465These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21466failures.
21467
21468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214698.3. Advanced logging options
21470-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021471
21472Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21473just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21474options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21475for more information about their usage.
21476
21477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214788.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21479------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021480
21481It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021482HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021483commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21484monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21485ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21486
21487 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21488 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21489 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21490 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21491
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021492 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21493 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021494
21495 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21496 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21497 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21498
21499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215008.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21501----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021502
21503The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21504what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21505or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021506"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021507just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21508log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21509after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21510is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21511with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21512with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21513
21514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215158.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21516------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021517
21518Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21519for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21520"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21521retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21522raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21523a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21524file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21525you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21526"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21527
21528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215298.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21530--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021531
21532Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21533multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21534them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21535"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21536logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21537error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21538and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21539too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21540useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21541alternative.
21542
21543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215448.4. Timing events
21545------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021546
21547Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21548reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21549the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21550frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021551mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21552addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21553
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021554Timings events in HTTP mode:
21555
21556 first request 2nd request
21557 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21558 t tr t tr ...
21559 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21560 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21561 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21562 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021563 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021564 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21565
21566Timings events in TCP mode:
21567
21568 TCP session
21569 |<----------------->|
21570 t t
21571 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21572 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21573 |<------ Tt ------->|
21574
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021575 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021576 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021577 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21578 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21579 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021580 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021581 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21582 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21583 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21584 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021585
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021586 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21587 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21588 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021589 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21590 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21591 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21592 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21593 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21594 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021595
21596 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21597 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21598 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21599 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21600 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21601 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21602 request typed by hand during a test.
21603
21604 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21605 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021606 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021607 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21608 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21609 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21610 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021611
21612 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21613 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21614 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21615 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21616 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21617
21618 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21619 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21620 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21621 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21622 connection never established.
21623
21624 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21625 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21626 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21627 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21628 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21629 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21630 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21631 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21632 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21633 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21634 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21635
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021636 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21637 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21638 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21639 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21640 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21641 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21642
21643 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21644
21645 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21646 "Ta" can never be negative.
21647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021648 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21649 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021650 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21651 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021652 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021653
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021654 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021655
21656 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021657 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21658 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021659
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021660 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21661 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21662 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21663 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21664 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21665 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21666 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21667 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21668
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021669These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21670protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21671that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021672due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21673"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21674that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021675
21676Most common cases :
21677
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021678 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21679 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21680 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21681 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21682 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021683 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021684 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21685 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21686 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21687 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21688 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021689 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021690
21691 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21692 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21693 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21694 of ms on remote networks.
21695
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021696 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21697 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21698 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021700 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21701 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021702 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021703 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21704 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21705 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21706 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21707 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21708 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021709
21710Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021712 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021713 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021714 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021715
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021716 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021717 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21718 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21719
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021720 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021721 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21722 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21723 flags.
21724
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021725 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21726 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021727 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21728 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21729 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21730 the client connection was maintained open.
21731
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021732 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021733 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021734 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021735 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21736
21737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217388.5. Session state at disconnection
21739-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021740
21741TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21742"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
217432-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21744each of which has a special meaning :
21745
21746 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21747 session to terminate :
21748
21749 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21750
21751 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21752 server explicitly refused it.
21753
21754 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21755 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21756 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21757 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021758 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021759
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021760 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021761 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021762
21763 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21764 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21765 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21766 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21767 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21768
21769 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21770 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21771 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21772 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21773 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21774
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021775 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021776 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21777
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021778 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021779 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21780 backup connections when going up.
21781
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021782 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021783
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021784 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21785 send or receive data.
21786
21787 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21788 send or receive data.
21789
21790 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21791 with nothing left in the buffers.
21792
21793 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21794
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021795 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021796 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21797
21798 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21799 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21800 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21801 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21802 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21803
21804 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21805 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21806
21807 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21808 server (HTTP only).
21809
21810 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21811
21812 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21813 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21814 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21815
21816 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21817 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21818 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21819
21820 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21821
21822 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21823 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21824
21825 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21826 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21827 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21828
21829 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21830 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021831 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21832 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021833
21834 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21835 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21836 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21837 another server.
21838
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021839 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021840 server.
21841
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021842 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21843 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21844 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21845 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21846
21847 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21848 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21849 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21850 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21851
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021852 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21853 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21854 "use-server" rule).
21855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021856 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21857
21858 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21859 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21860
21861 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21862
21863 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21864 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21865 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21866
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021867 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21868 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021869 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021870 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21871 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21872
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021873 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21874
21875 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21876 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21877
21878 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21879
21880 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21881
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021882The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21883was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021884helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21885starvation, attacks, etc...
21886
21887The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21888alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21889easier finding and understanding.
21890
21891 Flags Reason
21892
21893 -- Normal termination.
21894
21895 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021896 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21897 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021898 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21899
21900 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21901 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021902 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21903 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021904 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21905 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021906
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021907 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21908 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021909 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021910
21911 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21912 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21913 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21914
21915 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21916 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21917 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21918 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21919 the server takes too long to respond.
21920
21921 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21922 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21923 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21924 long a time to respond.
21925
21926 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21927 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21928 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021929 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021930 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21931 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021932
21933 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21934 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21935 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21936 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21937 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021938 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021939 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21940 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21941 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21942 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21943 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21944 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21945 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21946 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021947 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021948 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21949 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21950 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021951
21952 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21953 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021954 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21955 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21956 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21957 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021958
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021959 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021960 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21961
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021962 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021963 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21964 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021965 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021966 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21967 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21968
21969 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21970 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21971 503 or 504 here.
21972
21973 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021974 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021975 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21976 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21977 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21978
21979 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21980 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021981 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021982 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021983 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021984
21985 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21986 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21987 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21988 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21989 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21990 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021991 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021992
21993 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21994 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21995 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21996 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21997 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21998 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21999 solution is to fix the application.
22000
22001 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22002 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22003 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22004 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22005 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22006 external attacks.
22007
22008 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022009 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022010 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022011 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22012 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22013
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022014 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22015 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22016 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022017 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022018 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022020 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22021 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22022 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22023 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022024 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22025 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22026 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22027 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
22028 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022029
22030 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22031 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22032 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
22033 returned an HTTP 403 error.
22034
22035 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22036 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22037 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22038 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22039
22040 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22041 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22042 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22043 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22044
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022045The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022046persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022047important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22048re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22049
22050 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22051
22052 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22053 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22054 set on a GET request.
22055
22056 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22057 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022058 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022059 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22060
22061 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22062 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22063 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22064
22065 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22066 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22067 already got a cookie.
22068
22069 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22070 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22071 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22072 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22073 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22074
22075 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22076 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22077 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22078
22079 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22080 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22081 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22082
22083 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22084 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22085
22086 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22087 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22088 then advertised in the response.
22089
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220918.6. Non-printable characters
22092-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022093
22094In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22095consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22096converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22097prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22098being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22099escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22100is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22101'}' when logging headers.
22102
22103Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22104issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22105containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22106
22107Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22108the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22109performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22110
22111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22113---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022114
22115Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22116achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022117section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022118cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22119the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22120the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022121locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022122not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22123user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22124a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22125wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22126
22127 Examples :
22128 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22129 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22130
22131 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22132 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22133
22134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221358.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22136---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022137
22138Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22139proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22140the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22141server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22142
22143Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22144response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022145section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146
22147It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022148time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22149appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022150are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22151and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22152follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22153request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22154in the logs.
22155
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022156As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22157frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22158an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022160 Example :
22161 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22162 listen proxy-out
22163 mode http
22164 option httplog
22165 option logasap
22166 log global
22167 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22168
22169 # log the name of the virtual server
22170 capture request header Host len 20
22171
22172 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22173 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22174
22175 # log the beginning of the referrer
22176 capture request header Referer len 20
22177
22178 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22179 capture response header Server len 20
22180
22181 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22182 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22183
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022184 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022185 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22186
22187 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22188 capture response header Via len 20
22189
22190 # log the URL location during a redirection
22191 capture response header Location len 20
22192
22193 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22194 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22195 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22196 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22197 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22198
22199 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22200 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22201 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22202 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022203 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022204
22205 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22206 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22207 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22208 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22209 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022210 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022211
22212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222138.9. Examples of logs
22214---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022215
22216These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22217them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22218reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22219
22220 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22221 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22222 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22223
22224 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22225 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22226
22227 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22228 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22229 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22230
22231 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22232 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22233
22234 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22235 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22236 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22237
22238 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022239 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022240 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22241 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22242
22243 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22244 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22245 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22246
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022247 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22248 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22249 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22250 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022251 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022252 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022253
22254 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022255 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022256
22257 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22258 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22259 Nothing was sent to any server.
22260
22261 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22262 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22263
22264 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22265 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022266 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022267 send a 408 return code to the client.
22268
22269 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22270 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22271
22272 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22273 5 seconds ("c----").
22274
22275 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22276 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022277 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022278
22279 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022280 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022281 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22282 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22283 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22284 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22285 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022286
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022287
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200222889. Supported filters
22289--------------------
22290
22291Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22292accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22293unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22294
22295See also : "filter"
22296
222979.1. Trace
22298----------
22299
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022300filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022301
22302 Arguments:
22303 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22304 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22305
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022306 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022308 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022309 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22310 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22311 amount of the parsed data.
22312
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022313 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022314
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022315This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22316callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22317information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22318filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22319
22320Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22321tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22322a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22323
22324
223259.2. HTTP compression
22326---------------------
22327
22328filter compression
22329
22330The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22331keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022332when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22333fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22334done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22335explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22336filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22337listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22338order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022339
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022340See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22341 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022342
22343
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200223449.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22345--------------------------------------------
22346
22347filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22348
22349 Arguments :
22350
22351 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22352 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22353 parsed.
22354
22355 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22356 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22357 part must be placed in its own scope.
22358
22359The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22360external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022361streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022362exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22363also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22364
22365SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22366the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22367
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022368For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022369"doc/SPOE.txt".
22370
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100223719.4. Cache
22372----------
22373
22374filter cache <name>
22375
22376 Arguments :
22377
22378 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22379
22380The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22381"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022382cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022383other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22384case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22385is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22386filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022387listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22388order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022389
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022390See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22391 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22392
22393
223949.5. Fcgi-app
22395-------------
22396
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022397filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022398
22399 Arguments :
22400
22401 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22402
22403The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22404request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22405reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22406used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22407implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22408used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22409fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22410used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22411order.
22412
22413See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22414 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22415
22416
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100224179.6. OpenTracing
22418----------------
22419
22420The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22421HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22422of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22423Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22424
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022425This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022426
22427The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22428HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22429participates in the work of HAProxy.
22430
22431filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22432
22433 Arguments :
22434
22435 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22436 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22437 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22438 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22439 OpenTracing filters.
22440
22441 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22442 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22443 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22444 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22445 filter must have its own scope defined.
22446
22447More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022448of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022449
22450
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002245110. FastCGI applications
22452-------------------------
22453
22454HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22455feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22456the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22457FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22458servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22459FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22460backend.
22461
22462HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22463application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22464connection.
22465
2246610.1. Setup
22467-----------
22468
2246910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22470--------------------------
22471
22472fcgi-app <name>
22473 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22474 document root must be defined.
22475
22476acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22477 Declare or complete an access list.
22478
22479 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22480 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22481 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22482 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22483 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22484
22485docroot <path>
22486 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22487 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22488 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22489
22490index <script-name>
22491 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22492 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22493 is an optional setting.
22494
22495 Example :
22496 index index.php
22497
22498log-stderr global
22499log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022500 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022501 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22502
22503 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22504 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22505
22506pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22507 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22508 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22509 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22510
22511 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22512 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22513 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22514 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22515
22516 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22517 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22518
22519path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022520 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022521 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22522 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22523 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22524 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22525 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22526 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22527 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022528
22529 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022530 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022531 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22532 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22533 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22534 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022535
22536 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022537 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22538 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022539
22540option get-values
22541no option get-values
22542 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22543
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022544 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022545 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22546
22547 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22548 application will accept.
22549
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022550 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22551 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022552
22553 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022554 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022555 option is disabled.
22556
22557 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22558 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22559 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22560 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22561 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22562 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22563
22564option keep-conn
22565no option keep-conn
22566 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22567 sending a response.
22568
22569 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22570 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22571
22572option max-reqs <reqs>
22573 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22574 accept.
22575
22576 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22577 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22578 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22579 to 1.
22580
22581option mpxs-conns
22582no option mpxs-conns
22583 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22584
22585 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22586 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22587
22588set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22589 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22590 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22591 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22592 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22593
22594 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22595 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22596 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22597
22598 Example :
22599 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22600 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22601
22602 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22603
22604
2260510.1.2. Proxy section
22606---------------------
22607
22608use-fcgi-app <name>
22609 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22610
22611 Arguments :
22612 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22613
22614 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22615 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22616 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22617 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22618 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22619
22620 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22621 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22622 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22623 application are evaluated.
22624
22625
2262610.1.3. Example
22627---------------
22628
22629 frontend front-http
22630 mode http
22631 bind *:80
22632 bind *:
22633
22634 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22635 default_backend back-static
22636
22637 backend back-static
22638 mode http
22639 server www A.B.C.D:80
22640
22641 backend back-dynamic
22642 mode http
22643 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22644 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22645
22646 fcgi-app php-fpm
22647 log-stderr global
22648 option keep-conn
22649
22650 docroot /var/www/my-app
22651 index index.php
22652 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22653
22654
2265510.2. Default parameters
22656------------------------
22657
22658A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22659the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022660script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022661applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22662
22663 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22664 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22665 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22666 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22667 | | |
22668 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22669 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22670 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22671 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22672 | | application. |
22673 | | |
22674 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22675 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22676 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22677 | | |
22678 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22679 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22680 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22681 | | the application's configuration. |
22682 | | |
22683 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22684 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22685 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22686 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22687 | | |
22688 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22689 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22690 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22691 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22692 | | be defined. |
22693 | | |
22694 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22695 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22696 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22697 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22698 | | is not set too. |
22699 | | |
22700 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22701 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22702 | | set. |
22703 | | |
22704 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22705 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22706 | | the request. |
22707 | | |
22708 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22709 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22710 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22711 | | |
22712 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22713 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22714 | | script to process the request. |
22715 | | |
22716 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22717 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22718 | | |
22719 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22720 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22721 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22722 | | |
22723 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22724 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22725 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22726 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22727 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22728 | | |
22729 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22730 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22731 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22732 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22733 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22734 | | side. |
22735 | | |
22736 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22737 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22738 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22739 | | connected to. |
22740 | | |
22741 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22742 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22743 | | |
22744 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022745 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22746 | | current HAProxy version. |
22747 | | |
22748 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022749 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22750 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22751 | | |
22752 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22753
22754
2275510.3. Limitations
22756------------------
22757
22758The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22759way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22760during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22761establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22762application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22763or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22764message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22765these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22766and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22767
22768Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22769request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22770requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22771
22772About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22773into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22774fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22775"http-request" ones.
22776
22777Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22778FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22779processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22780must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22781here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022782
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022783
2278411. Address formats
22785-------------------
22786
22787Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22788address.
22789
22790This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22791The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22792of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22793equivalent is '::'.
22794
22795Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22796is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22797
22798This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22799family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22800
22801Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22802configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22803use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22804'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22805
22806Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22807socket type and the transport method.
22808
22809
2281011.1 Address family prefixes
22811----------------------------
22812
22813'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22814
22815'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22816 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22817 listening.
22818
22819'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22820 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22821 on the statement using this address, a port or
22822 a port range may or must be specified.
22823
22824'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22825 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22826 using this address, a port or a port range
22827 may or must be specified.
22828
22829'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22830 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22831 using this address, a port or a port range
22832 may or must be specified.
22833
22834'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22835 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22836 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22837 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22838 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22839 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22840
22841'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22842 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22843 start by slash '/'.
22844
22845
2284611.2 Socket type prefixes
22847-------------------------
22848
22849Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22850type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22851this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22852This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22853but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22854
22855Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22856instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22857
22858If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22859they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22860report this to the maintainers.
22861
22862'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22863 to "stream"
22864
22865'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22866 to "datagram".
22867
22868
2286911.3 Protocol prefixes
22870----------------------
22871
22872'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22873 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22874 socket type and transport method is forced to
22875 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22876 this address, a port or a port range can or
22877 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22878 of 'stream+ip@'.
22879
22880'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22881 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22882 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22883 statement using this address, a port or port
22884 range can or must be specified.
22885 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22886
22887'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22888 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22889 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22890 statement using this address, a port or port
22891 range can or must be specified.
22892 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22893
22894'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22895 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22896 socket type and transport method is forced to
22897 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22898 this address, a port or a port range can or
22899 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22900 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22901
22902'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22903 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22904 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22905 the statement using this address, a port or
22906 port range can or must be specified.
22907 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22908
22909'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22910 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22911 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22912 the statement using this address, a port or
22913 port range can or must be specified.
22914 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22915
22916'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22917 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22918 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22919
22920'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22921 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22922 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22923
22924In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22925QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022927/*
22928 * Local variables:
22929 * fill-column: 79
22930 * End:
22931 */